Epson IR-320 Technical Reference Manual

Epson IR-320 Technical Reference Manual

advertisement

Assistant Bot

Need help? Our chatbot has already read the manual and is ready to assist you. Feel free to ask any questions about the device, but providing details will make the conversation more productive.

Manual
Epson IR-320 Technical Reference Manual | Manualzz
Technical
Reference Manual
IR-320
Issued Date
,
,
Issued by
EPSON
English
404368102
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
CONFIDENTIALITY AGREEMENT
BY USING THIS DOCUMENT, YOU AGREE TO ABIDE BY THE TERMS OF THIS AGREEMENT. RETURN THIS
DOCUMENT IMMEDIATELY IF YOU DO NOT AGREE TO THESE TERMS.
❏
This document contains confidential, proprietary information of Seiko Epson Corporation or its affiliates. You
must keep such information confidential. If the user is a business entity or organization, you must limit disclosure
to your employees, agents, and contractors who have a need to know and who are also bound by obligations of
confidentiality.
❏
On the earlier of (a) termination of your relationship with Seiko Epson or (b) Seiko Epson’s request, you must stop
using the confidential information. You must then return or destroy the information, as directed by Seiko Epson.
❏
If a court, arbitrator, government agency, or the like orders you to disclose any confidential information, you must
immediately notify Seiko Epson. You agree to give Seiko Epson reasonable cooperation and assistance in resisting
disclosure.
❏
You may use confidential information only for the purpose of operating or servicing the products to which the
document relates, unless you obtain the prior written consent of Seiko Epson for some other use.
❏
Seiko Epson warrants that it has the right to disclose the confidential information. SEIKO EPSON MAKES NO
OTHER WARRANTIES CONCERNING THE CONFIDENTIAL INFORMATION OR ANY OTHER
INFORMATION IN THE DOCUMENT, INCLUDING (WITHOUT LIMITATION) ANY WARRANTY OF TITLE
OR NON-INFRINGEMENT. Seiko Epson has no liability for loss or damage arising from or relating to your use of
or reliance on the information in the document.
❏
You may not reproduce, store, or transmit the confidential information in any form or by any means (electronic,
mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise) without the prior written permission of Seiko Epson.
❏
Your obligations under this Agreement are in addition to any other legal obligations. Seiko Epson does not waive
any right under this Agreement by failing to exercise it. The laws of Japan apply to this Agreement.
CAUTIONS
❏
This document shall apply only to the product(s) identified herein.
❏
No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form or by any
means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise, without the prior written permission of
Seiko Epson Corporation.
❏
The contents of this document are subject to change without notice. Contact us for the latest information.
❏
While every precaution has been taken in the preparation of this document, Seiko Epson Corporation assumes no
responsibility for errors or omissions.
❏
Neither is any liability assumed for damages resulting from the use of the information contained herein.
❏
Neither Seiko Epson Corporation nor its affiliates shall be liable to the purchaser of this product or third parties
for damages, losses, costs, or expenses incurred by the purchaser or third parties as a result of accident, misuse, or
abuse of this product or unauthorized modifications, repairs, or alterations to this product or (excluding the U.S.)
failure to strictly comply with Seiko Epson Corporation's operating and maintenance instructions.
❏
Seiko Epson Corporation shall not be liable against any damages or problems arising from the use of any options
or any consumable products other than those designated as Original EPSON Products or EPSON-Approved
Products by Seiko Epson Corporation.
Rev. C
i
TRADEMARKS
®
EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation.
Intel and Celeron are registered trademarks of Intel Corporation.
Microsoft, MS-DOS, Windows and Windows NT are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation.
CompactFlash is a trademark of SanDisk Corporation.
BaySwap is a trademark of Phoenix Technologies Ltd.
General Notice: Other product and company names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be
trademarks of their respective companies.
ii
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Revision Information
Revision
Page
Rev. A
Rev. B
Rev.C
Rev. C
Altered Item and Contents
First release
1-16
Change the DSW1 settings
3-25
Add the OS Recovery method of step 4
B-3
Add the Jumper and Switch Settings
3-65,66,67,68,69
5-1,14,15,16,27
Add the HDD Power Down Settings.
5-1,12,14,15,16,25,27
Add the BIOS Ver.2.11.02.
1-18,19,20,21
Change the Dimensions.
5-12,25
Add the Onboard Lan Boot ROM.
iii
Key to Symbols
The symbols in this manual are identified by their level of importance, as defined below. Read
the following carefully before handling the product..
WARNING:
Provides information that must be followed carefully to avoid bodily injury.
CAUTION:
Provides information that must be observed to prevent damage to the equipment or
loss of data.
❏ Possibility of causing bodily injuries.
❏ Possibility of causing physical damage.
❏ Possibility of causing information loss.
Note:
Provides important information and useful tips on the operation of the equipment and the necessary
limitation matters to maintain the performance of the product,
Precautions
WARNING:
❏ Turn off the main power switch immediately and unplug the power cable if the IR-320
produces smoke, a strange odor, or unusual noise.
Continued use may lead to fire or electric shock. Contact your dealer or an EPSON service center for advice.
❏ Never disassemble or modify this product.
Tampering with this product may result in injury, fire or electric shock.
❏ Never install this product and connect the cable while occurring thunder to avoid shock.
❏ Always use a specified power supply.
Using the other power supply may lead to fire or shock.
❏ Never insert or disconnect the power plug with wet hands.
Doing so may result in severe shock.
❏ Do not allow foreign objects to fall into this product.
These foreign objects may lead to fire or shock.
❏ If water or other liquid spills into this product, turn off the power switch, unplug the power
cable immediately.
Continued usage may lead to fire or shock.
iv
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
❏ Do not place multiple leads on the power outlet. Overloading the outlet may lead to fire.
Always supply power directly form a standard domestic power outlet.
❏ Handle the power cable with care.
Improper handling may lead to fire or shock.
Do not modify or attempt to repair the cable.
Do not place any heavy object on the cable.
Avoid excessive bending, twisting, and pulling of the cable.
Do not place the cable near heating equipment.
Check that the plug is clean before plugging it in.
Be sure to push the prongs all the way in.
❏ Make sure that the wall outlet can be accessed easily in order to unplug the power cable
from it immediately in case of emergency.
❏ Regularly remove the power plug from the outlet and clean the base of the prongs and
between the prongs.
If you leave the power plug in the outlet for a long time, dust may collect on the base of the prongs, causing
a short and fire.
CAUTION:
❏ Do not connect devices other than those specified in this manual.
Doing so may result in fire or improper operation.
❏ Do not set this product in the unstable place (such as on a shaky stand or a place that is not
level).
The product may break or cause injury if it falls.
❏ Do not use the unit in locations subject to high humidity or dust levels.
Excessive humidity and dust may cause equipment damage, fire or shock.
❏ Do not stand or place any heavy object on top of this product.
The equipment may fall or collapse, causing breakage and possible injury.
❏ When leaving this product unused for a long time, always unplug it from the outlet to
ensure safety.
❏ The devices of the circuit board may become hot. Turn off the power and wait 10 minutes
before accessing them.
❏ Wait more than 10 seconds after turning off the power supply before turning it on again.
Rev. C
v
❏ Do not use the product in the place where inflammable liquids (gasoline, benzine or thinner)
may be in the air.
Doing so may cause an explosion or fire.
❏ Do not drop, bump or otherwise subject this product to strong vibration or impact.
Doing so may damage the product.
❏ Do not block the openings on this product that protect it from overheating.
Overheating may lead to fire.
Do not place this product in a narrow place with bad ventilation such as a closet or a
bookcase.
Do not place this product on a carpet or a cushion.
Do not cover this product with cloth such as a blanket or a tablecloth.
❏ Do not connect the unit to an AC outlet that is close to devices that generate voltage
fluctuations or electrical noise. In particular, stay clear of devices that use large electric
motors.
The IR-320 and the POS system may not function correctly.
❏ Always connect the power cable to the AC inlet of this product before plugging it into the
wall outlet.
❏ Be sure to push the plug of the power cable into the AC inlet of this product.
❏ When the power cable for the TM printer is connected, do not short-circuit its connector
pins.
Because pins are exposed, this connector may lead to the short-circuit when not connected to the TM
printer.
❏ Do not insert fingers or foreign matter into the CD-ROM drive disk tray or the CD-R/RW
drive disk tray or openings.
Doing so may lead to fire, shock or injury.
❏ Never hold up this product by the rear cover, the CD-ROM drive disk tray or the CD-R/RW
drive disk tray or the front panel.
It may fall can cause damage or injury.
❏ Make sure that the total power requirements of all devices receiving power from this
product do not exceed the power limitation.
It may cause trouble.
❏ Always use this product with the rear cover and the side cover attached.
If they are not attached, foreign matter may enter this product and it may result in fire or improper
operation.
vi
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
❏ When the protection circuit of the IR-320 operates (such as, in case of over-current or when
the temperature rises extraordinarily), turn off the side (main) power switch and leave it off
about 10 minutes after solving the problem; then turn on the side switch and the front power
switch in order again.
Note:
❏ Be sure to use EPSON supplied or specified DIMMs, HDDs, and CPUs.
❏ If you install a board in the PCI slot, use one that was confirmed by EPSON. Contact your
EPSON dealer for a list of approved devices. If you use any other device, please consider
that it is your responsibility to choose the correct device.
❏ When installing an application, find out from the dealer where you bought it whether it is
appropriate.
About This Manual
Aim of the Manual
This manual was created to provide information on the IR-320 for anyone who is developing
applications.
Contents of the Manual
The table below is just a summary. A complete table of contents appears at the end of this
section. See it for detailed information and page numbers.
The configuration of the manual is as follows:
Chapter 1,”IR-320 System Overview”
Describes the hardware configuration, the
software configuration, the jumper position,
and others
Chapter 2,”Setup”
Describes how to set up the IR-320 and its
options
Chapter 3,”OS Information”
Describes the preinstalled OS (Windows 2000/
NT/98/95, MS-DOS) and the configurations
and setups of various drivers
Chapter 4,”Utilities”
Describes each utility and how to set them up
Chapter 5,”BIOS setup”
Describes the BIOS setup.
Chapter 6,”Device Diagnosis Utility”
Describes the Device Diagnosis Utility
Chapter 7,”Hardware Specifications”
Describes items such as system, memory,
interruption, switch, and indicator
Rev. C
vii
Appendix A,”Wake On LAN”
Describes the BIOS setup, the Power On Self
Test, and the device self-diagnosis utility
Appendix B,”IR-310 versus IR-320”
Describes differences between the IR-310 and
IR-320
Appendix C,”Serial Handshaking”
Describes the Serial Handshaking
Related Manuals
Related Manuals
viii
Name
Comments
IR-320 User’s Manual
Describes the basic setup and operation procedure.
IR-320 Service Manual
Describes the maintenance and repair procedure for IR-320 service
engineers.
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Contents
Revision Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Key to Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
About This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Aim of the Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Contents of the Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Related Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
iii
iv
iv
vii
vii
vii
viii
ix
Chapter 1 IR-320 System Overview
About the IR-320 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Model Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Unpacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
IR-320 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Part Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DM-LR121Series LCD Display Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DM-LR104T LCD Display Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
CD-ROM, CD-R/RW Drive (OI-R06) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Front CompactFlash Drive (OI-R07) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Connector Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hardware Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Model Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operation Testing Products for IR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Software Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
BIOS Setup and Self-Diagnosis Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operating Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Utilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operation Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(1) Mechanical Off Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(2) Soft Off Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(3) Full On Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(4) Video Off Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(5) Suspend Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Jumper Locations and Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Main Board Jumpers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
POS 320 Board Jumpers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Functions of SW2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
IR-320 Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Main Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Peripheral Dimensions of the LCD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Peripheral Dimensions of the Customer Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Peripheral Dimensions of the Printer Tray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions When the Printer Unit is Mounted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-1
1-1
1-1
1-1
1-3
1-3
1-4
1-5
1-5
1-6
1-7
1-7
1-8
1-9
1-9
1-9
1-9
1-10
1-10
1-10
1-10
1-10
1-11
1-13
1-13
1-15
1-17
1-18
1-18
1-18
1-19
1-20
1-20
1-21
Chapter 2 Setup
Overview of the setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Precautions for Setting Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operations Before Setting Up the IR-320 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operation Testing Products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
How to Install Options/Peripheral Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing a DIMM (Memory) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Removing the DIMM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing a 2.5" HDD Unit (OI-HDD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(1) Removing the HDD unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing a 3.5" HDD Unit (OI-HDD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rev. C
2-1
2-2
2-3
2-3
2-4
2-5
2-6
2-7
2-7
2-11
ix
Confidential
Installing a CD-ROM Drive , CD-R/RW Drive (OI-R06) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17
Installing a Front CompactFlash Card Adapter (OI-R07) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
Installing an LCD Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
DM-LR121Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25
DM-LR104T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27
Removing the LCD Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
DM-LR121Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
DM-LR104T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32
Installing an 84-Key Keyboard Unit (DM-KR084) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
Removing an 84-Key Keyboard Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37
Installing a Battery Unit (OI-R03) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
Setting the BIOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42
Installing a 28-Key Keyboard Unit (DM-K028) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43
Handling Precaution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44
Changing a Key Top . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
Installing the MSR Unit (DM-MR123) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48
Mounting onto an LCD Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-49
Mounting an MSR Unit to a 28-Key Keyboard Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50
Installing a Printer Tray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-52
Installing a Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54
Installing a TM Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54
Installing a Dedicated TM Printer Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55
Installing a PCI Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-60
Installing a Customer Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-62
Installing a Mouse/Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-67
Installing a Cash Drawer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-68
Attaching a Power Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-69
Installing Peripheral Devices to the COM Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70
Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70
Printing Using Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72
Chapter 3 OS and Drivers
Outline of This Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
Operating Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
Drivers and Utilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
Windows 2000 Pre-Installed Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Directory Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Windows 2000 Setup Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
Setting the recognition range of the double click . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
Various Configurations (Windows 2000) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
Setting the Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
EPSON Serial Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
AC line tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
Power button prohibited setting tool for windows 2000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
Adding Windows 2000 Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
Support Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12
Recovering the OS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13
Windows NT Pre-Installed Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15
Directory Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
Windows NT Setup Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Adding the Windows NT Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Support Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18
Recovering the OS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19
Windows 98 Pre-Installed Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21
Directory Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22
Windows 98 Set-Up Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23
Recovering the OS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24
x
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Installation for Windows XP Professional Locally Procured Edition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Intel Chipset Diver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Network Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Touch Panel Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Serial Port Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the AC line tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation for Windows 2000 Professional Locally Procured Edition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Intel Chipset Diver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Network Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Sound Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Touch Panel Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting the recognition range of the double click . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Serial Port Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the AC line tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power button prohibited setting tool for windows 2000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation for Windows NT Locally Procured Edition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Network Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing Service Pack 6a . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ultra DMA Setting for the HDD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Video Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Sound Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Touch Panel Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation for Windows 98 Locally Procured Edition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setup Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Chipset Driver for Intel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ultra DMA Setting for the HDD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Network Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Video Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Sound Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Touch Panel Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the AC line tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power button prohibited setting tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation for MS-DOS Locally Procured Version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the CD-ROM Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Network Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Touch Panel Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting of Touch Panel Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Touch Panel Driver for Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Touch Panel Driver for MS-DOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
HDD Power Down Timer Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Shift to the HDD power ON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3-26
3-26
3-28
3-28
3-29
3-29
3-30
3-31
3-31
3-34
3-34
3-35
3-36
3-36
3-37
3-37
3-38
3-40
3-40
3-41
3-42
3-42
3-43
3-44
3-44
3-46
3-46
3-47
3-47
3-48
3-49
3-50
3-51
3-51
3-52
3-52
3-54
3-54
3-54
3-55
3-57
3-57
3-57
3-64
3-65
3-68
Chapter 4 Utilities
Types of Utilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
How to Obtain Each Utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Keyboard Firmware Related Utilities (MSR, Key Lock, 28-key Keyboard) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Keyboard Firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
How to Use Keyboard Firmware Related Utilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Keyboard Firmware Setting Utility (for Windows XP/2000/NT/98) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
OPOS ADK Settings with the DM-MR123 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Key Lock Setting Utility (for Windows XP/2000/NT/98) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rev. C
4-1
4-4
4-5
4-5
4-6
4-8
4-10
4-10
4-12
4-12
4-12
xi
Confidential
Speed Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
Key Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
Setting the Key Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
Key Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15
Saving the Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15
Loading the Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16
New . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16
Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16
28-Key Definition Utility (for Windows XP/2000/NT/98) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17
Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17
Speed Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18
Key Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19
Setting the Key Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19
Setting the Key Top Color . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20
Key Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21
Saving the Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22
Loading the Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22
New . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22
Displaying the Key Top . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
List of Definable Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
Layer 28-key Keyboard Definition Utility (for Windows XP/2000/NT and Windows 98) . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
Outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
Software Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27
Uninstall Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
Setting the Utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
84-key Configuration Utility (for Windows XP/2000/NT/98) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-43
Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-43
Speed Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-44
Key Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45
Setting the Key Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45
Keytop Color Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46
Key Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46
Saving the Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46
Loading the Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46
New . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47
Keytop View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47
Printing the Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47
Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47
Automatic Definition Data Setting Utility (for Windows XP/2000/NT/98) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48
Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48
Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48
Setting File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-49
Logon Tool (for Windows XP/2000/NT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-50
Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-51
How to Use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-51
EPSON OPOS ADK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52
Creating the Component Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52
Software Standardization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53
EPSON Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53
Keyboard Firmware Setting Utility for MS-DOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53
Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53
Processing Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-56
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-56
28-Key Configuration Utility for MS-DOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58
Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58
How to Operate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59
List of Definable Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-60
84-key Configuration Utility (for MS-DOS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61
xii
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Basic Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
File Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Load Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Save Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Edit Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Download Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quit Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automatic Definition Data Setting Utility (For MS-DOS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Processing Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ending Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
File Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Code Conversion Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Management Driver APM2.0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Confirmation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Notes for Use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AC Line Tool (For Windows 2000/98) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Button Tool (For Windows 2000) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
BaySwap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operation procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-62
4-62
4-62
4-63
4-63
4-64
4-65
4-66
4-66
4-67
4-67
4-67
4-67
4-68
4-69
4-69
4-71
4-71
4-71
4-73
4-74
4-75
4-76
4-78
4-78
4-79
Chapter 5 BIOS Functions
Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
HDD Power Down Timer Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
BIOS Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operating Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Changing settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
BIOS Setup Main Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standard CMOS Features Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Advanced BIOS Features Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Advanced Chipset Features Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Integrated Peripherals Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Management Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Supplementary Explanation for Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PNP/PCI Configurations Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Defaults and Selectable Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standard CMOS Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Advanced BIOS Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Advanced Chipset Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Integrated Peripherals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Management Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PnP/PCI Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting a Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power On Self-Test (POST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-1
5-1
5-2
5-2
5-3
5-3
5-4
5-5
5-7
5-10
5-11
5-13
5-15
5-17
5-18
5-18
5-21
5-23
5-23
5-27
5-29
5-31
5-32
Chapter 6 Device Diagnostics Utility
Conditions for Running Device Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Startup/Exit/Initialize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Screen Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Use for the device diagnostic utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operating Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rev. C
6-1
6-3
6-3
6-7
6-7
xiii
Confidential
Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Device Test Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
Chapter 7 Hardware Specifications
System Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1
System Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2
I/O Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
DMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
System Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Hardware Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
CPU (Celeron-PPGA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
Memory (168-pin DIMM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
Video Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
IDE Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
Serial Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
PCI Slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
Three-terminal regulators for the drawer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
Ethernet Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
Power Supply Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
Lithium Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
Serial Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
Parallel Connector (LPT Connector) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
External TM Power Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
DKD Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
Customer Display Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12
Appendix A Wake On LAN
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-1
Objective of Wake On LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-1
Settings for Using Wake On LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-1
Wake On LAN Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-1
Basic Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-2
Software Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-2
BIOS Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-2
Wake On LAN Method Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-3
Magic Packet Received . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-3
Reference Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-3
MAC Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-3
Appendix B The IR-310 Compared to the IR-320
Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-1
Hardware Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
Jumper and Switch Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
Option Comparison . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-4
Software Comparison . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-5
Comparison for Driver, Tool, and Utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-6
Appendix C Serial Handshaking
Overview of the TM Printer and the Customer Display Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-1
Possible Combinations of Handshaking for the TM Printers and the Customer Displays . . . . . . . . . C-1
Connection Differences for Customer Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-1
Flow Control Selections for Different Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-1
Windows Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-2
Device Settings When Software Requires XON/XOFF Handshaking with Jumper JP32 Open . . . . C-2
Device Settings When Software Requires XON/XOFF Handshaking with Jumper JP32 Shorted . . C-3
Device Settings When Software Requires DTR/DSR Handshaking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-4
Device Settings When Software Requires RTS/CTS Handshaking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-5
xiv
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Chapter 1
IR-320 System Overview
About the IR-320
The IR-320 is a POS personal computer with a built-in touch panel. In addition to capability of
Network connection, the IR-320 is flexible for configuring various systems with abundant
devices in an OLE-POS based system.
Model Configuration
The IR-320 has various model configurations with combinations of an operating system, CPU,
HDD, CD-ROM drive, LCD unit, and printer. Please contact your dealer for details.
Unpacking
For the unpacking, see the User’s Manual packed with the system.
IR-320 Features
❏ Simplicity
•
Employing the touch panel enables even a beginner to operate the product easily. It is
possible to learn how to use the system in a very short time.
•
It is designed for quick and easy setup and maintenance.
❏ Space saving
•
Rev. C
All the functions needed for the POS system, such as the printer and the LCD with the
touch panel, are in the small space of 252 mm wide and 457 mm deep (including the rear
cover).
IR-320 System Overview 1-1
❏ Abundant options for superior expandability
•
A model having the type of LCD and printer that meet a customer’s need can be
selected.
•
Various options such as the CD-ROM drive, Front CompactFlash Adapter, 28- key unit,
and MSR unit can be installed.
•
Various peripherals can be connected to the PCI slots and serial ports.
•
It has an AC outlet that can work together with the system.
❏ Security
•
Data can be protected from being stolen by key-locking of the front cover.
•
Six access levels can be set by using different types of manager keys. Owners or
managers can set different levels of access to the system.
•
The battery backup (option) can prevent data from being lost due to a power out.
❏ High performance
•
Power and speed needed for processing data is offered.
•
Memory can be expanded to a maximum of 512 MB.
•
The BIOS supports APM 1.2, ACPI 1.0b, Plug & Play, SMBIOS 2.2 (DMI), and Wake On
LAN.
1-2 IR-320 System Overview
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Part Names
The figures below show the part names of the IR-320.
DM-LR121Series
eries LCD Display Unit
lock lever
POWER LED
HDD LED
Rev. C
LCD brightness
adjustment buttons
IR-320 System Overview 1-3
DM-LR104T LCD Display Unit
paper FEED button
customer display (option)
keylock
printer unit
(option)
HDD LED
POWER LED
LCD unit (option)
main power switch
front cover key lock
MSR unit (option)
front cover
lock switch
soft power switch
main power switch
USB
rear cover
keyboard/mouse
connector
1-4 IR-320 System Overview
side cover
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
CD-ROM, CD-R/RW Drive (OI-R06)
CD-ROM,
CD-R/RW drive
reset switch
volume
Front CompactFlash Drive (OI-R07)
front CompactFlash adapter
Rev. C
eject button
IR-320 System Overview 1-5
Connector Names
The figures below show the connectors on the IR-320.
Customer display
switch
Customer display
connector
TM power connector
Fuse
Drawer kick connector
AC inlet
AC outlet
COM5 port
PCI slots
COM6 port
LAN LEDs
Ethernet connector
LPT port
MIC
Line-In
COM2 port
Line-Out
COM1 port
USB connector
Display connector
Main power switch
MSR
USB
1-6 IR-320 System Overview
KB/mouse
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Hardware Configurations
The IR-320 is an IBM® PS/2®-compatible system specifically designed for the POS environment.
The IR-320 has the following features:
❏ Intel Celeron processors are used. These high speed CPU processors offer the power and
speed needed for data processing.
❏ Two 168-pin DIMM sockets enable a maximum of 512MB RAM memory.
❏ One 88.9 mm {3.5"} HDD or two 63.5 mm {2.5"} HDDs can be installed internally.
❏ An optional CD-ROM drive , CD-R/RW drive or FrontCompactFlash adapter can be
installed internally.
❏ An Ethernet controller supports 10 BASE-T/100 BASE-TX.
❏ Contains two PCI slots.
❏ Compact size of 252 × 386 × 250 mm (W × D × H) {9.9 × 15.2 × 9.8"}(Without Rear Cover).
❏ An AC outlet (max. 3A) that is on whenever the system is on.
Model Configurations
The IR-320 can be configured with the following optional units:
❏ LCD units (with touch panel)
SVGA LCD unit (with touch panel)
264 mm {10.4"} color TFT
310 mm {12.2"} color TFT
310 mm {12.2"} color TFT
Model name DM-LR104T
Model name DM-LR121SL *
Model name DM-LR121SV
❏ POS keyboard units
84-key
28-key
Model name DM-KR084
Model name DM-KR028
❏ Printer units
Thermal printer (58 mm, 80 mm {2.3", 3.2"}) Model name TM-T88IIIR
Serial dot impact printer
Model name TM-U210AR **
Thermal receipt with slip
Model name TM-H3000R
❏ MSR units
ISO/JIS I tracks 1, 2, and 3
Model name DM-MR123
❏ Customer display units
20 × 2-line display
20 × 2-line display
256 × 64 dots graphic display
Model name DM-D110
Model name DM-D210
Model name DM-D500
❏ Battery unit (for IR-320/IR-310)
Model name OI-R03-021
* For Europe, only project base.
** For Europe, not longer available.
Rev. C
IR-320 System Overview 1-7
❏ CD-ROM drive (for IR-320/ IR-310)
Model name OI-R06-002
❏ CD-R/RW drive (for IR-320/ IR-310)
Model name OI-R06-202
(An application that writes to the CD-R/RW must be added.)
❏ Front CompactFlash Adapter (for IR-320/IR-310)
Model name OI-R07
❏ Memory
256MB
128MB
Model name OI-DIMM-256
Model name OI-DIMM-128
❏ HDD
2.5" HDD
3.5" HDD
Model name OI-HDD-300
Model name OI-HDD
❏ TM printer tray
For TM-H6000
For other TMs
Model name OI-R01-022
Model name OI-R01-001
❏ TM printer
Printer tray setting type
❏ External mounting type
Model name TM-U200 series
Model name TM-H6000 series
Model name TM-T88II series
Model name TM-U675 series
Model name TM-T285 series
Model name TM-H5000 series
Operation Testing Products for IR
The Operation Confirmed items are marketed by EPSON and are built-in, included, or
connected to an EPSON POS product, and operation by has been confirmed by EPSON. EPSON
can also offer reference information for the selection of peripheral devices to the customer who
constructs a system using EPSON POS products. Please inquire what kind of device can be used
from EPSON or the selling agent.
This operation confirmation evaluates the equipment in test environments and conditions, but it
does not guarantee the operation. Therefore, procurement and evaluation by the customer are
required.
1-8 IR-320 System Overview
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Software Configurations
BIOS Setup and Self-Diagnosis Functions
BIOS setup defines the system configuration. When the product is set up for the first time, run
this program to set the system environment. To change the operating environment, run this
program again. See Chapter 5, “BIOS Functions.”
Operating Systems
The IR-320 runs on the standard Microsoft operating systems: MS-DOS®, Windows® 98 Second
Edition, Windows NT® WorkStation 4.0, Windows 2000 Professional and Windows XP
Professional.
Windows 2000 Professional, Windows NT Workstation 4.0 and Windows 98 Second Edition can
select the EPSON pre-installed HDD.
The IR-320 Driver CD-ROM that includes an appropriate driver for an operating system is
included.
See “OS Information” in Chapter 3.
Note:
The USB interface is not supported by Windows NT, and MS-DOS. (Windows NT supports the USB
Keyboard.)
Be sure to make the recovery media and back up the data. See ”Recovering the OS” in Chapter 3 for
details. When you need to repair the HDD, use the recovery disk.
Utilities
Driver software and utilities software that operate and set peripherals are provided for the
IR-320.
Appropriate setting utility software is provided for each peripheral related to keyboard
firmware such as 28-key unit, MSR unit, and key lock.
Windows driver software is provided for the printer, customer display, and drawer. Contact
your dealer for the latest drivers and utilities information.
Rev. C
IR-320 System Overview 1-9
Operation Modes
The IR-320 has the following five operation modes.
(1) Mechanical Off Mode
In the mechanical off mode, the main power switch is off. No power is supplied to the IR-320
main body, and the power in all circuits is off.
To turn on the power to the IR-320, first turn on the main power switch.
(2) Soft Off Mode
In the soft off mode, only the main power switch is on. Items such as the clock circuit, backup
circuit, and power management circuit inside the IR-320 are on in the standby state. To save the
backup data after the power is off, the main power switch should remain on.
When the system is in the soft off mode, it can be put in full on mode by software, by pressing
the soft off switch, by a wake up signal from the LAN or by a ring signal from the modem.
(3) Full On Mode
In the full on mode, the main power switch and the soft power switch are on. The system is in
the normal operating state. Even if the system is started by a wake-up request signal from the
LAN, the full on mode is produced.
To turn off the IR-320 power, turn the power off from the software. The power-off operation
differs slightly, depending on the setting of the APM driver. See Chapter 4 “Utility“.
(4) Video Off Mode
When no input operation is performed for a given period of time during operation in the full on
mode, only the LCD and the backlight circuits are turned off, thus extending the service lifetime
for the LCD peripheral parts.
Depending on which operating system (OS) is used, the setup method for the time for transfer to
the video off mode differs. The setup method for each OS is described below.
Windows NT does not support the video off mode; therefore, the LCD and the backlight circuits
cannot be turned off during operation.
Type of OS
Setup method for time of transfer to video off mode
Windows XP
Set by [Power Options] property — [Turn off monitor]
Windows 2000
Set by [Power Options] property — [Turn off monitor]
Windows 98
Set by [Power Management] property — [Turn off monitor]
MS-DOS
No setting
When “Power Button Tool“ is installed, Win 98 and Win 2K can realize “No-Operation“.
In the video off mode, the unit immediately returns to the full on mode when input is received
from the keyboard, mouse, or touch panel.
1-10 IR-320 System Overview
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Note that the reset operation differs, depending on the BIOS setting for the switch, when the soft
power switch is pressed during the video off mode.
BIOS [Soft-Off by PWR-BTTN] setting
Type of OS
OS Setting
Instant-Off
Delay 4 Sec.
Disabled
Windows XP
Shutdown
Full-on
Full-on
Shutdown
Standby
Full-on
Full-on
Standby
Never
No-Operation
Shutdown
Full-on
Full-on
Shutdown
Standby
Full-on
Full-on
Standby
Standby
Full-on
Full-on
Standby
Forced power off
Reset to the full on
mode
Windows 2000
Windows 98
MS-DOS
When “Power Button Tool“ is installed, Win 98 and Win 2K can realize “No-Operation“.
For Windows 2000, even if the soft power switch is pressed accidentally in the video off mode, it
stays in the video off mode.
(5) Suspend Mode
Turning off such items as the LCD, backlight circuit, and CPU when there is no input operation
for a specified time period in the full on mode extends the life of these parts.
In Windows 98, click Start, select Shut Down, and then select Standby in the Shut Down dialog.
In Windows NT, do not set up Suspend, because the system clock is delayed..
Type of OS
Setup method for time of transfer to suspend mode
Windows XP
Set with [Power Management] property — [ System Standby]
Windows 2000
Set with [Power Management] property — [ System Standby]
Windows NT
Do not set up.
Windows 98
Set with [Power Management] property — [System Standby]
MS-DOS
Set with BIOS [Suspend Timer]
In the suspend mode, the mode is immediately reset to the full on mode when input is received
from the keyboard, mouse, HDD,FDD or touch panel. Also, the suspend mode is always
changed to the full on mode when the soft power switch is pressed, regardless of the BIOS
switch setting.
Rev. C
IR-320 System Overview 1-11
The status transition between each operation mode is as follows.
a. Main power switch on
b. Main power switch off or power off forced by AC power cutoff
c.
Soft power switch on , wake-up request signal received from the LAN or ring signal from
the modem.
d. System shutdown by software (The operation differs, depending on the dedicated APM
driver setting. See Chapter 4 “Utility“.) and forced power off by pressing the soft power
switch (if the dedicated APM driver is used)
e. Transfer to the video off mode after no input operation for a specified period or selection of
video off mode at Operation System.
f.
Input operation from keyboard, mouse, or touch panel
Reset by pressing the soft power switch (if the dedicated APM driver is used)
g. Main power switch off or forced power off because of AC power cutoff
h. Transfer to suspend mode because of no input operation for a specified period or selection
of suspend mode at Operation System.
i.
Input operation from keyboard, mouse, or touch panel
Reset by pressing the soft power switch
1-12 IR-320 System Overview
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Jumper Locations and Settings
Main Board Jumpers
The figure below shows the locations of the main board connectors and jumpers.
Rev. C
IR-320 System Overview 1-13
List of main board jumpers
Address
Default setting
Description
Remarks
JP1
1-2
For system use
Not changeable
JP5
1-2
Do not clear/clear RTC and CMOS
See “JP5 settings (RTC and CMOS clear),” below
JP7
Short
COM1 power output setting
JP8
Open
See “Settings for JP7 to 18 (COM1, COM2, COM5,
COM6 power output),” below
JP9
Open
JP10
Short
JP11
Open
JP12
Open
JP13
Short
JP14
Open
JP15
Open
JP16
Short
JP17
Open
JP18
Open
JP 25
1-2 fixed
For system use
Not changeable
JP31
1-2
TM reset polarity setting
See “JP31 settings (TM reset polarity settings)” on
page 1-15
JP32
1-2
TM/customer display flow control
See “JP32 settings (TM/customer display flow
control)” on page 1-15
COM2 power output setting
COM5 power output setting
COM6 power output setting
JP5 settings (RTC and CMOS clear)
JP5
RTC clear
1-2 (default)
Normal operations
2-3
Clear
Settings for JP7 to 18 (COM1, COM2, COM5, COM6 power output)
COM1
COM2
COM5
COM6
Jumper short-circuited
Pin 1 function in the DB9 connector
JP7 (Default)
DCD signal
JP8
+5 V of electrical power
JP9
+12 V of electrical power
JP10 (Default)
DCD signal
JP11
+5 V of electrical power
JP12
+12 V of electrical power
JP13 (Default)
DCD signal
JP14
+5 V of electrical power
JP15
+12 V of electrical power
JP16 (Default)
DCD signal
JP17
+5 V of electrical power
JP18
+12 V of electrical power
1-14 IR-320 System Overview
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
JP31 settings (TM reset polarity settings)
JP31
Dedicated TM reset
1-2 (default)
Active LOW
2-3
Active HIGH
This indicates the polarity of the signal when RTS or DTR is reset.
Set JP3 on the POS board when RTS or DTR is reset.
JP32 settings (TM/customer display flow control)
JP32
Dedicated TM flow control
Customer display flow control
Dedicated TM reset
1-2
RTS/CTS
DSR
DTR
2-3 (default)
DTR/DSR
CTS
RTS
Set JP3 on the POS board when RTS or DTR is reset.
POS 320 Board Jumpers
The POS circuit board unit has two jumpers, one switch, and one four-polarity DIP switch that
can be set.
Parts Side (faces down when installing into the IR-320)
DSW1
JP3
SW2
Back Side
JP1
Rev. C
IR-320 System Overview 1-15
Functions of JP3 and DSW1
POS board
4
1
ON
1
3
JP3
DSW1
JP3:
Use this jumper to make a TM printer reset using RTS or DTR effective.
DSW1:
Use this DIP switch to select the default value of the country mode of the MSR. And also use the
switch when the keyboard cannot be used due to a setting error.
The functions of the three jumpers and the DIP switch are shown below.
JP3 settings (TM reset enable/disable setting for RTS and DTR)
JP3
Dedicated TM reset
1-2
Reset enabled for RTS and DTR
2-3 (default)
Reset disabled for RTS and DTR (reset only with RSTDRV)
DSW1 settings (DIP switch settings for keyboard controller)
SW
Description
4 (default: OFF)
Start-up mode (OFF: normal mode; ON: system boot)
SW1
SW2
SW3
Country
OFF
OFF
OFF
US (Default)
ON
OFF
OFF
Japan
OFF
ON
OFF
France
ON
ON
OFF
German
OFF
OFF
ON
Spain
Up = Off; Down = On
Start-up mode
By switching to the enforced boot mode, it is possible to start up the system using the default
settings. This mode is designed for instances when start-up is impossible because of
overwriting of firmware and system variables. The enforced boot can be performed only
from an external keyboard. The MSR, 28-key keypad, and similar devices cannot be used.
Country setting
The country setting amends the default settings (such as MSR readers, K/B settings, and
28-key and 84-key default settings) when the settings are initialized and during an enforced
boot start-up.
1-16 IR-320 System Overview
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Functions of SW2
customer display connector
SW2
If you want to loop back the DTR and the DSR of the customer display port, set this switch to the
[1] side. This function might be needed when a system using a previous version of OPOS
controls a TM printer, without attaching a customer display.
Normally, set this switch to the [0] side.
Functions of SW2
Customer display loop-back jumper
Dedicated TM reset
[1] side
Loop back DTR and DSR.
[0] side (default)
Normally used.
LCD setting jumper switch
The LCD setting jumper switch is located on the POS 320 board.
LCD setting jumper switch
LCD jumper switch settings
LCD setting jumper
LCD units
1-2
DM-LR104T-252 / LR121SL / LR121SV
2-3
DM-LDM-LR104T-052
Rev. C
IR-320 System Overview 1-17
IR-320 Usage
See the IR-320 User’s Manual.
Dimensions
Main Body
252 mm {9.9"}
271 mm
{10.7"}
386 mm {15.2"}
454.5 mm {17.9"}
1-18 IR-320 System Overview
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Peripheral Dimensions of the LCD
541 mm {21.3"} - (DM-D500)
518 mm {20.4"} - (DM-D110)
454.5 mm {17.9"}
121Type:490mm{19.3"} /104Type:460 mm{18.1"}
121Type:317mm{12.5”} /104Type:297 mm{11.7”}
306 mm {12.1"} - (DM-D110)
121Type:295mm{11.6”}/104Type:266 mm{10.5”}
329 mm {13.0"} - (DM-D500)
121Type:555mm{21.9"} /104Type:521 mm {20.5"}
The 121 type is the case size of the DM-LR121Series, and the 104 type is the case size of the
DM-LR104T.
121Type:249mm{9.8"}/104Type:208 mm {8.2"}
121Type:273mm{10.8"}/104TYpe:234 mm {9.2"}
121Type:310mm /104Type:276 mm
121Type:255mm /104Type:320 mm
121Type:425mm /104Type:390 mm
The 121 type is the case size of the DM-LR121Series, and the 104 type is the case size of the DMLR104T.
Rev. C
IR-320 System Overview 1-19
Peripheral Dimensions of the Customer Display
DM-D500:83mm{3.3"}
DM-D110:69 mm{2.7"}
129 mm(DP-504)
{5.1"}
227 mm
{8.9"}
The dimensions in ( ) indicate the dimensions of the DP-504 with the extension prop.
Peripheral Dimensions of the Printer Tray
Dimensions when the OI-R101-001 is mounted.
178 mm {7.0"}
263 mm {10.4"}
1-20 IR-320 System Overview
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Dimensions when the dedicated printer TM-H6000 is attached to the OI-R01-022.
368 mm {14.5"}
40 mm {1.6"}
Dimensions When the Printer Unit is Mounted
TM-T88IIIR:262mm{10.3"}
TM-U210AR:283mm{11.1"}
TM-H3000R:327 mm {12.9"}
Rev. C
IR-320 System Overview 1-21
1-22 IR-320 System Overview
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Chapter 2
Setup
This chapter explains how to set up options and peripheral units of the IR-320.
Overview of the setup
The peripherals of the IR-320 include the ones that are set by a driver or a utility at the time of
setup and must confirm in the operation. Peripherals may not operate correctly if the installation
order of OS and driver is not correct.
The basic flow of the setup is described below.
Printer/Customer display
/Cash drawer
28/84-Keyboard/MSR/ KeyLock
Installing OS
Installing the dedicated
customer display, the cash
drawer and so on.
Operating confirmation with
Device Diagnostics Utility
Installing OS
Installing the 28/84-Keyboard/ MSR
Setting the keyboard firmware
with the keyboard firmware
setting utility./Making the
definition data file.
Setting to define automatically
for more than one system
The setup completion
Rev. C
Setup 2-1
Confidential
Battery
Attaaching the battery unit
Installing OS
Setting the BIOS
Installing the APM driver
(only Windows NT)
Installing the Power Button
tool (for Windows 98/2000)
Required
Optional
Installing the AC line tool
(for Windows 2000/XP)
The setup completion
Refer to each item about the other peripheral devices and options.
Precautions for Setting Up
In addition to the precautions below, warning instructions and cautions to note are given at each
work stage.
CAUTION:
❏ Turn off the power for all equipment, including the IR-320 and all peripherals, before
setup. Turn off the main (side) power switch for the IR-320. Unplug the power cables
for the IR-320 and its peripheral units from the outlet. If the power is not turned off, the
IR-320 or peripheral units may be damaged during setup.
❏ When the battery unit is installed and the power is on, do not turn off the main (side)
power switch or unplug the power cable until you put the IR-320 in the soft off mode
with the soft (front) power switch. Then you can turn off the main power switch and
unplug the power cable. If the main power switch is turned off or the power cable is
unplugged when the unit is in full on mode, power starts flowing from the battery
unit. If power starts flowing from the battery unit, turn ON the main power switch,
which stops the power supply from the battery unit.
2-2 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
❏ Static electricity can damage the components of the IR-320. Before you touch any
components, touch a grounded metal surface to discharge the static electricity in
your body. It is also recommended that you wear a grounded wristband and work
on an antistatic surface.
❏ Do not touch the connectors. Dirt may cause a malfunction.
❏ Do not apply excessive force to connectors, cables, or screws during connection.
Excessive force may damage the connectors or the screw threads.
❏ Do not allow cables to be pinched. The cables may be damaged or disconnected.
Operations Before Setting Up the IR-320
Before setting up the IR-320, complete the following operations:
1. If Windows is running, exit it. The resulting power off condition is called “soft off.” Proceed
to step 4.
2. Press the soft (front) power switch once and let go. The resulting power off condition is also
called “soft off.” Proceed to step 4. If the power does not go off, proceed to step 4.
3. Press the soft power switch again, and hold it down for 4 seconds or more. The power
supply to the IR-320 will go off.
4. Turn off the main (side) power switch. The resulting power off condition is called
“mechanical off.”
5. When the battery unit is attached, remove it.
6. Unplug the power cable. Confirm that power supplies to all peripheral units are off and
unplug the connection cables from them.
Operation Testing Products
The operation confirmation products are the ones that are built-in, included, or connected to
EPSON POS products, and their operation has been confirmed by EPSON. EPSON can offer
reference information for the selection of peripheral devices to the customer who constructs a
system using an EPSON POS product. Please ask EPSON or the selling agent what kind of
device can be used.
This operation confirmation evaluates the operation of the products in a usual environment, but
does not guarantee the operation. Therefore, the customer is basically responsible for the
procurement and the evaluation of the equipment.
Rev. C
Setup 2-3
Confidential
How to Install Options/Peripheral Units
See the following pages for instructions on setting up each option or peripheral.
Option/Peripheral
Page
Installing a DIMM (Memory)
2-5
Installing a 2.5" HDD Unit (OI-HDD) *1
2-7
Installing a 3.5" HDD Unit (OI-HDD) *1
2-11
Installing a CD-ROM Drive , CD-R/RW Drive (OI-R06)*2
2-17
Installing a Front CompactFlash Card Adapter (OI-R07)*2
2-21
Installing an LCD Unit
2-24
Installing an 84-Key Keyboard Unit (DM-KR084) (DM-KR084)
2-35
Installing a Battery Unit (OI-R03)
2-39
Installing a 28-Key Keyboard Unit (DM-K028)
2-43
Installing the MSR Unit (DM-MR123)
2-48
Installing a Printer Tray
2-52
Installing a Printer
2-54
Installing a PCI Board
2-60
Installing a Customer Display
2-62
Installing a Mouse/Keyboard
2-67
Installing a Cash Drawer
2-68
Attaching a Power Cable
2-69
*1: The 2.5" HDD unit (OI-HDD) and the 3.5" HDD unit (OI-HDD) cannot be installed together.
*2: The CD-ROM drive (OI-R06) and the front CompactFlash adapter (OI-R07) cannot be installed together.
Note:
Don’t use a serial mouse.
2-4 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Installing a DIMM (Memory)
DIMMs (memory) are installed in the DIMM sockets on the main board.
One 128MB DIMM is standard on the IR-320. Two DIMM sockets (168-pin type), which can
increase the memory to 512MB, are available. Remove the DIMM originally installed, and install
the two DIMMs instead.
CAUTION:
❏ Static electricity can damage the components of the IR-320. Before you touch any
components, touch a grounded metal surface to discharge the static electricity in
your body. It is also recommended that you wear a grounded wristband and work
on an antistatic surface.
❏ Do not touch the DIMM connectors. Dirt may cause a malfunction.
❏ If it is difficult to insert the DIMM, do not apply excessive force to the DIMM. If
excessive force is used, the connection parts may be damaged. Remove the DIMM,
check the connection part to confirm that no problem exists, and then insert it
again.
The DIMM is installed by using the following procedure:
1. Slide the right side cover down until it comes off.
2. Remove the two screws from the side panel, and remove the side panel by pulling it out
while lifting it.
Rev. C
Setup 2-5
Confidential
3. Match the two notches in the DIMM to the projections on the socket, and push the DIMM
until it clicks and stands upright.
Note:
When two DIMMs are installed, use the farthest socket first.
4. Reattach the side panel with two screws.
5. Reattach the side cover.
Removing the DIMM
To remove the DIMM, unlock the lock pins located on both sides of the DIMM socket, and pull
the DIMM straight up.
2-6 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Installing a 2.5" HDD Unit (OI-HDD)
The IR-320 has one or two 2.5" HDDs or one 3.5" HDD, according to its specifications. Up to two
2.5" HDDs can be installed.
For information on installing the 3.5" HDD unit (OI-HDD), see the following section, “Installing
a 3.5" HDD Unit (OI-HDD).”
To install a 2.5" HDD, remove the HDD unit currently installed in the IR-320, install the optional
HDD, and reinstall original the HDD unit in the IR-320. Install the optional HDD using the
following procedure.
CAUTION:
Do not subject the HDD unit to shock or vibration. Because the HDD unit is a precision
instrument, do not subject it to even the slightest shock or vibration.
(1) Removing the HDD unit
1. Open the front cover of the IR-320. If the front cover is locked, unlock it with the front key.
To unlock the front cover, insert the key into the front lock, and push in slightly while you
turn it.
front cover
2. Open the HDD cover by lightly pressing down on the upper pin lock.
Rev. C
Setup 2-7
Confidential
3. Remove the two screws from the HDD unit.
4. Pull the HDD unit toward the front slightly while watching the cables, and remove the two
cables for the HDD unit from the their connectors.
5. Remove the HDD unit.
6. Remove the four screws from the HDD unit, and remove the HDD plate.
HDD plate
2-8 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
7. When removing the HDD drive, remove the four screws for the HDD drive as shown in the
figure below, and remove it.
removing the HDD in the lower drive bay
removing the HDD in the upper drive bay
(2) Installing the HDD
1. Install the HDD in the HDD unit, and attach it with four screws.
installing the HDD in the lower drive bay
installing the HDD in the upper drive bay
2. When you use two HDDs, set the jumpers to make one a “master” and the other a “slave.”
To make an HDD a master drive, remove the jumper. To make an HDD a slave, set the
jumper.
Note:
When you use two drives, one must be a master and one must be a slave. The IR-320 will not boot
from the slave drive.
An HDD may be set to either a master or slave, whether it is installed in the upper drive bay or the
lower drive bay.
Rev. C
Setup 2-9
Confidential
3. Attach the HDD plate with four screws.
HDD plate
(3) Installing the HDD unit
Install the HDD unit using the steps below. If you are installing the HDD where the cables will
be hidden, as shown in step 3 of “Removing the HDD unit,” use the steps for “Installing the
HDD unit where the cables will be hidden” later in this section.
1. Push the HDD unit into the IR-320 from the front. Be careful not to subject the HDD to shock
or vibration, and be sure the cables are not pinched. Confirm that the projection on the
mounting plate under the HDD is firmly engaged with the frame projection on the IR-320.
projection on HDD mounting plate
frame projection
2. Connect the two cables for the HDD unit to their connectors.
2-10 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
3. Lock the HDD unit with two screws.
4. Reattach the HDD cover.
5. Close the front cover.
6. Turn on the IR-320, start up the BIOS setup, and confirm that the HDD is normally
identified. For information on the BIOS setup, see Chapter 5, “BIOS Functions.”
Installing a 3.5" HDD Unit (OI-HDD)
The IR-320 has one or two 2.5" HDDs or one 3.5" HDD, depending on its specifications. Up to
two 2.5" HDDs can be installed.
For information on installing the 2.5" HDD units (OI-HDD), see the previous section, “Installing
a 2.5" HDD Unit (OI-HDD).”
The IR-320 does not start up though the battery unit (OI-R03) as the option is connected to the
IR-320.
To install the 3.5" HDD, remove the currently installed HDD unit from the IR-320, install the
optional HDD in the HDD unit, and reinstall the HDD drive bay in the IR-320.
Install the optional HDD using the following procedure.
CAUTION:
Because the HDD unit is a precision instrument, do not subject it to even the slightest
shock or vibration.
Rev. C
Setup 2-11
Confidential
(1) Removing the HDD unit
1. Open the front cover of the IR-320. If the front cover is locked, unlock it with the key. (You
may need to press in slightly as you turn the key.)
front cover
2. Open the HDD cover by lightly pressing down on the upper pin lock.
3. Unscrew two screws and remove the HDD faceplate.
2-12 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
4. Remove the left side cover by sliding it downward.
5. Remove the two screws attaching the side panel.
6. If a PCI card is installed, remove it. Remove the screw locking the PCI card and pull the PCI
card out.
Rev. C
Setup 2-13
Confidential
7. Remove the two cables for the HDD unit from their connectors.
8. Remove the HDD unit from the front while watching the cables.
9. Remove the two cables from the HDD unit.
10. Remove the four screws from the HDD unit, and remove the HDD mounting plate.
2-14 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
(2) Installing the HDD
Install the HDD using the following procedure:
1. Attach the HDD to the HDD mounting plate with four screws.
2. Set the HDD jumper as shown in the below figure.
The jumper setting depends on the make and model of the HDD. Set the jumper for your
HDD.
3. Connect the two cables to their connectors.
Rev. C
Setup 2-15
Confidential
(3) Installing the HDD unit
1. Slide the HDD unit into the IR-320 from the front, being careful not to subject it to shock or
vibration, and be sure the cables are not pinched. Confirm that the projection on the
mounting plate under the HDD is firmly engaged with the frame projection on the IR-320.
projection on the HDD
mounting plate
frame projection
2. Connect the two cables for the HDD unit to their connectors.
2-16 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
3. Lock the HDD unit with two screws.
4. Reattach the HDD cover.
5. Insert the removed PCI card.
6. Reattach the side panel with two screws.
7. Reattach the side cover.
8. Close the front cover.
9. Turn on the IR-320, start up the BIOS setup, and confirm that the HDD is identified
normally. For information on the BIOS setup, see Chapter 5, “BIOS Functions.”
Installing a CD-ROM Drive , CD-R/RW Drive (OI-R06)
The optional 24× CD-ROM drive (OI-R06) or CD-R/RW drive (OI-R06-202) is installed using the
following procedure:
Note:
The CD-R/RW drive can write, but you must prepare the application to write.
Rev. C
Setup 2-17
Confidential
CAUTION:
Because the CD-ROM, CD-R/RW drive is a precision instrument, do not subject it to even
the slightest shock or vibration; otherwise, the CD-ROM, CD-R/RW drive may stop
operating.
Install the CD-ROM, CD-R/RW drive by following the steps below.
1. Open the front cover of the IR-320. If the front cover is locked, unlock it with the key. (You
may need to press in slightly as you turn the key.)
front cover
2. Remove the HDD cover.
3. Remove the CD-ROM cover. (Keep this cover because it is not used while the CD-ROM, CDR/RW drive is installed.)
2-18 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
4. Remove the left side cover by sliding it downward.
5. Remove two screws attaching the side panel.
6. Attach the cable set to the CD-ROM, CD-R/RW drive.
Rev. C
Setup 2-19
Confidential
7. Push the CD-ROM, CD-R/RW drive into the IR-320 from the front, being careful not to
subject it to shock or vibration, and be sure the cables are not pinched. Confirm that the
projection under the CD-ROM, CD-R/RW drive is firmly engaged with the frame projection
on the IR-320. If the cable for the HDD unit is in the way of the connection for the CD-ROM,
CD-R/RW drive, remove the HDD unit cable, connect the cable for the CD-ROM, CD-R/RW
drive, and re-connect the HDD unit cable.
projection under the
CD-ROM, CD-R/RW drive
frame projection
8. Connect the cable for the CD-ROM, CD-R/RW drive to the connector.
9. Attach the CD-ROM, CD-R/RW drive with one screw.
screw hole
10. Reattach the HDD cover.
2-20 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
11. Reattach the side panel with two screws.
12. Reattach the side cover.
13. Close the front panel.
Installing a Front CompactFlash Card Adapter (OI-R07)
CAUTION:
The front CompactFlash card adapter is precise equipment; so handle it gently. When
you remove and install the front CompactFlash card adapter. be careful not to subject
it to small shock, vibration or bending, because this may damage it.
Card type
Power supply
I/F mode
Connection to the main body
One Type I or Type II
+3.3 V/50 mA (max.)
True IDE mode
Secondary IDE bus (master) connection
1. Open the front cover of the IR-320. If the front cover is locked, unlock it with the key. (You
may need to press in slightly as you turn the key.)
front cover
Rev. C
Setup 2-21
Confidential
2. Remove the HDD cover.
3. Remove the CD-ROM cover. (Keep this cover because it is not used while the front
CompactFlash card adapter is installed.)
4. Remove the left side cover by sliding it downward.
5. Remove two screws attaching the side panel.
2-22 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
6. Push the front CompactFlash card adapter into the IR-320 from the front, being careful not to
subject it to shock or vibration, and be sure the cables are not pinched. Confirm that the
projection under the front CompactFlash card adapter is firmly engaged with the frame
projection on the IR-320. If the cable for the HDD unit is in the way of the connection for the
front CompactFlash card adapter, remove the HDD unit cable, connect the cable for the front
CompactFlash card adapter, and re-connect the HDD unit cable.
projection under the front
CompactFlash card adapter
frame projection
7. Attach the front CompactFlash card adapter with one screw.
8. Connect the cable for the front CompactFlash card adapter to the connector.
9. Reattach the HDD cover.
10. Reattach the side panel with two screws.
Rev. C
Setup 2-23
Confidential
11. Reattach the side cover.
12. Close the front panel.
Installing an LCD Unit
Three LCD units are available:
LCD unit
Type
Display size
Resolution
DM-LR104T
TFT
10.4" {26.42 cm}
SVGA 800x600
DM-LR121SL
TFT
12.1" {30.73 cm}
SVGA 800x600
DM-LR121SV
TFT
12.1" {30.73 cm}
SVGA 800x600
The 84-keyboard (DM-KR084) can be installed instead of an LCD unit.
DM-LR121Series
DM-LR104T
❏ Attach the ferrite core (an accessory of the IR-320) to the appointed cable.
❏ Select the touch panel driver from the type of the LCD unit, and install when the OS is
installed.
Note:
When you connect another type of the LCD unit, you need to install another touch panel driver. For
details, ask your dealer.
Description of jumper switch for each LCD unit
LCD unit
Jumper switch
DM-LR104T-052
2-3
DM-LR104T-252
1-2
DM-LR121SL
1-2
DM-LR121SV
1-2
2-24 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
DM-LR121Series
1
Remove the left side cover by sliding it downward.
2
Remove the two screws from the printer unit or the printer tray.
3
Remove the printer unit or the printer tray. When removing the printer unit, remove the
printer cable from the connector.
4
Thread the two cables for the LCD unit through the hole in the center of the IR-320.
Rev. C
Setup 2-25
Confidential
5
Engage the right and left tabs on the IR-320 with the right and left grooves in the back of the
LCD unit. When both sides are engaged, slide the LCD unit down while pressing the lock
lever on the left side of the LCD unit.
groove in the LCD unit
tab on the IR-320
6
The LCD unit has a 34-pin connector cable and a 38-pin connector cable. Attach the ferrite
core (an accessory of the IR-320) to the 34-pin connector cable.
7
Connect the cables for the LCD unit to their connectors.
layout of the connectors
CN51
CN31(38-pin)
CN35(34-pin)
JP1
Jumper Switch
POS board
8
Check the Jumper Switch setting. For the DM-LR121SV/DM-LR121SL, set the JP1 to “1-2.”
9
Install the printer unit or the printer tray, and lock it with two screws.
10 Reattach the side cover.
2-26 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
DM-LR104T
1. Remove the left side cover by sliding it downward.
2. Remove the two screws from the printer unit or the printer tray.
3. Remove the printer unit or the printer tray. When removing the printer unit, remove the
printer cable from the connector.
4. Set the lock knob under the LCD unit to the release position.
Rev. C
Setup 2-27
Confidential
5. Thread the two cables for the LCD unit through the hole in the center of the IR-320.
6. Engage the right and left tabs on the IR-320 with the right and left grooves in the back of the
LCD unit. When both sides are engaged, slide the LCD unit down on the back.
groove in the LCD unit
tab on the IR-320
7. The LCD unit has a 34-pin connector cable and a 38-pin connector cable. Attach the ferrite
core (an accessory of the IR-320) to the 34-pin connector cable.
ferrite core
2-28 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
8. Connect the cables for the LCD unit to the connectors.
layout of the connectors
CN51
CN31(38-pin)
CN35(34-pin)
JP1
Jumper Switch
POS board
9. Check the Jumper Switch setting. For the DM-LR104T-252, set the JP1 to “1-2,” and for the
DM-LR104T-052, set the JP1 to “2-3.”
Note:
If the jumper is incorrectly set, the LCD display is not correct.
10. Return the lock knob under the LCD unit to the lock position.
11. Install the printer unit or the printer tray, and lock it with two screws.
12. Reattach the side cover.
Rev. C
Setup 2-29
Confidential
Removing the LCD Unit
The removal procedure for the LCD depends on the type of LCD unit.
DM-LR121Series
1. Remove the left side cover by sliding it downward.
2. Remove the two screws from the printer unit or the printer tray.
3. Remove the printer unit or the printer tray. When removing the printer unit, remove the
printer cable from the connector.
printer cable
2-30 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
4. Remove the two cables for the LCD unit from their connectors.
5. Remove the ferrite core. Keep the removed ferrite core for installing on another LCD unit.
Rev. C
Setup 2-31
Confidential
6. Slide the LCD unit until it hits the upper limit of the slide range while pressing the lock lever
on the left side of the LCD unit.
Slightly pull the part circled in the illustration below in the direction of the arrow, and slide
the LCD unit upward further on the back.
Adjust the position of the LCD unit while watching the hole shown in the figure so that the
tabs of the main body can be disengaged from the grooves in the LCD unit.
Remove the LCD unit in the direction of arrow (5).
DM-LR104T
1. Remove the left side cover by sliding it downward.
2. Remove the two screws from the printer unit or the printer tray.
2-32 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
3. Remove the printer unit or the printer tray. When removing the printer unit, remove the
printer cable from the connector.
4. Remove the two cables for the LCD unit from their respective connectors.
5. Remove the ferrite core. Keep the removed ferrite core for installing on another LCD unit.
Rev. C
Setup 2-33
Confidential
6. Slide the lock located under the LCD unit to the right for unlocking.
7. Slide the LCD unit until it hits the upper limit of the slide range.
Slightly pull the part circled in the illustration below in the direction of the arrow, and slide
the LCD unit upward further on the back.
Adjust the position of the LCD unit while watching the hole shown in the illustration below
so that the tabs of the main body can be disengaged from the grooves in the LCD unit.
Remove the LCD unit in the direction of arrow (4).
2-34 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Installing an 84-Key Keyboard Unit (DM-KR084)
The 84-key keyboard can be installed instead of the LCD unit. The 84-key keyboard is installed
by using the following procedure.
1. Remove the left side cover by sliding it downward.
2. Remove the two screws from the printer unit or the printer tray.
3. Remove the printer unit or the printer tray. When removing the printer unit, remove the
printer cable from the connector.
4. Set the lock knob under the 84-key keyboard to the release position.
Rev. C
Setup 2-35
Confidential
5. Thread one cable of the 84-key keyboard through the hole in the center of the IR-320.
6. Engage the right and left grooves on the back of the keyboard with the right and left tabs on
the IR-320. When both sides are engaged, slide the LCD unit down on the back for
installation.
groove of the 84-key
keyboard
tab on the IR-320
7. Connect the 38-pin connector cable for the 84-key keyboard to connector CN31.
layout of the connectors
CN51
CN31(38-pin)
CN35(34-pin)
Jumper Switch
JP1
POS board
8. Set the Jumper Switch(JP1) to “1-2.”
9. Return the lock knob under the 84-key keyboard to the lock position.
2-36 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
10. Install the printer unit or the printer tray, and lock it with two screws.
11. Reattach the side cover.
Removing an 84-Key Keyboard Unit
1. Remove the left side cover by sliding it downward.
2. Remove the two screws from the printer unit or the printer tray.
3. Remove the printer unit or the printer tray. When removing the printer unit, remove the
printer cable from the connector.
printer cable
Rev. C
Setup 2-37
Confidential
4. Remove one cable for the 84-key keyboard from the connector, as shown below.
5. Slide the lock under the 84-key keyboard to the right to unlock it.
6. Slide the 84-key keyboard until it hits the upper limit of the slide range.
Slightly pull the part circled in the illustration below in the direction of the arrow, and slide
the LCD unit upward further on the back side.
2-38 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Adjust the position of the 84-key keyboard while watching the hole shown in the figure so
that the tabs on the main body can be disengaged from the grooves in the 84-key keyboard.
Pull the 84-key keyboard out.
Installing a Battery Unit (OI-R03)
The nickel-cadmium battery unit (OI-R03) backs up operations automatically if the power turns
off abruptly, such as in the case of a power interruption.
The specifications for the battery unit are as follows:
Type:
Charging time:
Charging method:
Ni-Cd 8-cell, 600 mAh
About 32 hours
Trickle
The charging and backup times change according to environmental conditions.
To use the battery unit, install the dedicated Power Management Driver APM2.0 supplied with
the battery unit. (for Windows NT)
Rev. C
Setup 2-39
Confidential
The battery unit begins to be charged when the IR-320 main (side) power switch is turned on.
After installing a battery unit, set System Battery to Equipped using the Power
Management menu in the BIOS setup utility. (See Chapter 6.)
Note (for Users in the United States):
The battery unit (OI-R03) is powered by a nickel-cadmium battery, which is recyclable. At the end of its
useful life, it is illegal under various state and local laws to dispose of this battery into the municipal waste
stream. Call 1-600-8-BATTERY for information on how to recycle this battery.
Note:
The battery unit is not charged even if power is being supplied and the main power switch is on unless the
power is in full on mode.
The battery unit cannot be used for the IR-320 connected with the 3.5” HDD.
The battery unit has not yet been charged when it is purchased. Charge the battery unit before using it.
The nickel-cadmium battery must be recycled or disposed of properly.
The life of the battery unit is approximately 2 to 2.5 years. Replace the battery unit accordingly.
Install the battery unit following the steps below.
1. Remove the left side cover by sliding it downward.
2-40 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
2. Remove the two screws from the printer unit or the printer tray.
3. Remove the printer unit or the printer tray. When removing the printer unit, remove the
printer cable from the connector.
printer cable
4. Set the battery unit in the battery unit box. Pull the tab of the battery box up, and insert the
battery unit into the battery box.
Rev. C
Setup 2-41
Confidential
5. Connect the cable of the battery unit as shown below.
6. Reattach the printer unit or the printer tray using two screws.
7. Reattach the side cover.
Setting the BIOS
After the battery unit is installed, change the BIOS setting by using the following procedure:
1. When an external keyboard is not connected to the IR-320, connect the external keyboard to
the mouse/keyboard connector.
2. Turn on the power supply to the IR-320.
3. While the following message is on the display, press Del:
Press DEL to enter SETUP.
4. The BIOS setup utility starts up.
5. Select Power Management Setup using the cursor keys and press Enter. The Power
Management Setup menu appears.
6. Select System Battery and change the setting to Equipped.
7. After completion of the setting, press Esc. The main menu resumes.
8. Select Save & Exit Setup using the cursor keys, and press Enter. A dialog appears. Press
Y and then Enter.
Installing a dedicated AC Line tool (Windows 2000/98)
The AC Line Tool is used to send a notification to the application that the system power has
been changed from the AC Line to the battery drive in Windows 2000/98.
Installing a dedicated APM driver (Windows NT Only)
When using the battery unit with Windows NT, install the dedicated APM driver included with
the battery unit.
❏ Power Management Driver APM2.0 for Windows NT
Refer to “Chapter 4 Utilities” for the installation procedure.
2-42 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Installing a 28-Key Keyboard Unit (DM-K028)
The 28-Key Keyboard unit is an optional input device for the IR-320. It has 28 keys in total, 4
columns by 7 lines. The function of each key can be freely assigned by software. By assigning the
same function to more than one key, these keys can be used as one large key. This keyboard also
can be used in connection with a magnetic stripe reader (MSR).
Note:
The software stored on the floppy disk is for the IR-300. So do not use it for this system.
Operation progress
1. Confirm that OS is installed.
2. Change the key top and the key top cover of the 28-Key Keyboard unit.
3. Set up the 28-Key Keyboard unit to the IR-320 main unit.
4. Turn the power of the IR-320 on and install the K/B firmware relation utility.
5. Using the utility, set the key definition and write the setting contents to the K/B firmware.
(The setting contents can be written and saved as the definition file.)
6. Now you can use the 28-Key Keyboard unit.
Setup procedure
Follow these steps to install the 28-Key Keyboard unit :
1. Remove the connector cover on the right side of the LCD unit. If an MSR unit is attached,
remove it.
Rev. C
Setup 2-43
Confidential
2. Connect the 28-Key Keyboard unit to the LCD unit.
3. Lock the 28-Key Keyboard unit with the four screws supplied with the 28-Key Keyboard
unit.
CAUTION:
Do not tighten the screws too tightly. If the torque is too strong, the screws might be
damaged.
Handling Precaution
While inputting data from the input devices connected to the keyboard interface, such as the
external keyboard and POS keyboard, do not input data from the MSR unit connected to the
28-Key Keyboard unit or the 28-Key Keyboard itself.
2-44 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Changing a Key Top
To change a key top on the keyboard unit, use the following procedure:
1. Insert the key top remover supplied with the keyboard unit into the key top that is to be
removed, as shown in the following figure:
2. When the key top remover is pulled up, the key top comes off.
3. To remove more than one key top, repeat steps 1 and 2.
4. Insert the new key top straight from the top.
Installing key top covers
Key top covers are supplied with the keyboard unit. The face of each key top is concave, and the
cover is installed on this key top. Install the key top cover using the following procedure:
Trim a piece of paper to the key size. Write down the key function on the paper, set it on the key
top, and install the key top cover on the key top. The key function can then be conveniently
identified at a glance.
1. Create a label for the key by trimming paper to the key size and writing the key function on
the label. Set the label on the key top.
Rev. C
Setup 2-45
Confidential
2. Snap the key top cover on the key top with the round concave facing upward. Firmly push it
until the key top cover clicks.
Removing the key top cover
To remove the key top cover, use the following procedure:
1. Take off the key top using the key top remover.
2. Turn the key top over, and push the key top cover off using a pin or a sharp-pointed tool.
Utility
For the keying-in using the 28-Key Keyboard unit, the definition data of each key must be set
using the utility and the setting contents must be written in the K/B firmware.
Refer to “Chapter 4 Utilities” about the installation and the way of using each utility.
Setting and writing the definition data of the 28-Key Keyboard in the K/B firmware
❏ The 28-key definition utility (The Windows version and the MS-DOS version)
Back up the definition data
The definition data is written in the K/B firmware but please back it up. The backup file is made
in the 28-Key Keyboard definition utility. The backup file is witten in the K/B firmware with the
definition data automatic setting utility. This way the same setting can be used for more than
one system to make a setup, and it can be used as a batch file.
2-46 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
❏ The definition data automatic setting utility (The Windows vertion, the MS-DOS version)
Using the layer function
❏ The 28-key definition utility compatible with the layer
❏ The 28-key automatic definition utility compatible with the layer for Windows version
❏ The 28-key automatic definition utility compatible with the layer for MS-DOS version
❏ The library for changing and reading the layer.
Rev. C
Setup 2-47
Confidential
Installing the MSR Unit (DM-MR123)
The LCD unit, the 84-key keyboard unit, and the 28-Key Keyboard unit are equipped with an
interface for connecting the MSR.
Usable magnetic cards:
ISO 7811, JIS X6301 type I track 1, 2, and 3
Note:
While inputting data from the input devices connected to the keyboard interface, such as the external
keyboard and the POS keyboard , do not input data from the 28-Key Keyboard unit or the MSR unit
Note:
The software stored on the floppy disk is for the IR-300. So do not use it for this system
Operation progress
1. Confirm that OS is installed.
2. Set up the MSR unit to the IR-320 main unit. There is a way of attaching to the LCD unit and
a way of to the 28-Key Keyboard unit.
3. Turn on the power of the IR-320 and install the K/B firmware relation utility.
4. Using the utility, write the MSR setting about in the K/B firmware directly. Or make a file
describing the setting contents with a text editor, and write it in the K/B firmware using the
utility.
5. It is now possible to input data of a magnetic card from the MSR unit.
2-48 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Mounting onto an LCD Unit
Connect the MSR unit to the LCD unit by following the procedure below.
1. Open the connector cover of the LCD unit.
2. Connect the MSR unit to the MSR interface.
3. Secure the MSR unit, using the two screws.
CAUTION:
Do not tighten the screws too tightly. If the torque is too strong, the screws might be
damaged.
Rev. C
Setup 2-49
Confidential
Mounting an MSR Unit to a 28-Key Keyboard Unit
Connect the MSR unit to the 28-Key Keyboard unit by following the procedure below.
1. Remove the connector cover on the upper side of the 28-Key Keyboard unit.
2. Connect the MSR unit to the 28-Key Keyboard unit.
3. Lock the MSR unit with the two screws supplied with the MSR unit.
CAUTION:
Do not tighten the screws too tightly. If the torque is too strong, the screws might be
damaged.
2-50 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Utility
In order to input the magnetic card data by using the MSR unit, use the utilites to set up reading
data match for various magnetic cards and writing in the K/B firmware of the setting contents.
Refer to “Chapter 4 Utililties” for the installation and the way of using for each utility.
Setting the function of the MSR unit and writing in the K/B firmware
❏ The keyboard firmware setting utility (The Windows version, the MS-DOS version)
Backup of the setting contents
Please make the file described the setting contents with the text editor and back it up. Write the backup file
in the K/B firmware with the definition data automatic setting utility. This way can be used to set up the
same setting for more than one system, and it can be used as the batch file.
❏ The definition data automatic setting utility (The Windows version, the MS-DOS version)
Rev. C
Setup 2-51
Confidential
Installing a Printer Tray
Dedicated printers are designed especially for the IR systems. Any of these printers can be
installed directly on the main body. When a dedicated printer is not used, a printer tray can be
installed and other types of TM printer can be installed on the printer tray.
Two types of printer tray can be connected to the IR-320.
Model name
Compatible printers
OI-R01-001
TM-T88 series, TM-U200 series
OI-R01-022
TM-H6000 series
Mount the printer tray by following the procedure below. If a TM printer is not being used,
begin with step 3.
1. Remove the portion shadowed in the figure below from the printer tray. Cut off the two
plastic connecting pieces (burrs) with a cutter or nippers, and pull the piece down toward
you. Bend the part back and forth two or three times, so that it can be cut off. Pass the cable
through the new opening.
CAUTION:
If burrs are left after the hatched part is removed, they may cause cuts or scratches.
Remove the burrs left on the printer tray with a cutter, or file them down.
2-52 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
2. To get power for the TM printer from the IR-320, remove one or more tabs from the DC cable
exit by breaking them off with a pair of pliers.
3. When setting up the TM printer on the printer tray, wrap the cable around the poles on the
other side of the tray, as shown below, to keep it out of the way.
4. Slide the printer tray in the direction of the arrow, and fit the hooks on the printer tray into
the slots in the IR-320.
OI-R01-001
Rev. C
OI-R01-022
Setup 2-53
Confidential
5. Attach the printer tray with two screws.
OI-R01-001
OI-R01-022
6. To get power for the TM printer from the IR-320, remove one or more tabs on the rear cover
to make a hole for cables to pass through.
7. Attach the rear cover with one screw.
8. Install the TM printer on the printer tray.
Installing a Printer
Dedicated printers are designed especially for the IR systems. Any of theses printers can be
installed directly on the main body. Other types of TM printer can be used on the printer tray
described in the previous section.
Installing a TM Printer
The power supply to the printer can be tapped from the TM power connector.
TM power supply
2-54 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
CAUTION:
When a dedicated printer unit and the TM printer are connected together, do not tap
power from the TM power connector. This connector does not have sufficient power for
two printers. Use an appropriate power supply (for example, the PS-170) available for
the TM printer.
The following TM printers can take power from the IR-320.
❏ TM-T85/88 series
❏ TM-U200 series
❏ TM-6000H series
For information on how to set up the TM printer, see the user’s guide for that printer.
Operation progress
1. Attach the printer tray to the IR-320.
2. Install the TM printer on the IR-320.
3. Confirm the operation of the TM printer.
4. The TM printer can be used.
Refer to the User’s Guide of each printer for the instalation and the operation confirmation
procedure of the TM printer.
Installing a Dedicated TM Printer Unit
The following dedicated TM Printer units are available:
Model Name
Specification
TM-T88IIR
Thermal printer (58 mm, 80 mm {2.3", 3.2"})
TM-U210AR
Serial impact dot matrix printer (two-color)
TM-H3000R
Thermal receipt with slip printer
TM-T88IIR
TM-U210AR
TM-H3000R
The serial port for the dedicated TM Printer unit is assigned to COM3 by default.
Rev. C
Setup 2-55
Confidential
Operation progress
1. Install the dedicated printer unit on the IR-320.
2. Turn on the power supply of the IR-320 and start up the Device Diagnostics Utility.
3. Confirm that the dedicated printer unit is connected correctly and it can print out by using
the Device Diagnostics Utility.
4. The dedicated printer unit can be used.
Note:
Refer to “Printing out by Windows” for printing from the Windows application to the dedicated printer
unit.
Setup procedure
Use the following procedure to connect the printer unit.
1. Turn on DIP switch 2-7 of the printer unit.
2. When connecting a customer display, set the baud rate to be the same for the dedicated
printer as the customer display by setting their DIP switches.
Note:
The customer display and the baud rate of the dedicated printer unit are set to the same speed at the factory
shipment.
3. Connect one end of the cable to the connector on the rear of the printer unit.
2-56 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
4. Bend the cable as shown below.
5. Remove the side cover by sliding it downward.
6. Remove the two screws as shown below.
Rev. C
Setup 2-57
Confidential
7. When a printer unit or printer tray is already installed, remove them. When removing the
printer unit, disconnect the printer cable for the IR-320.
printer cable
8. Connect the cable for the printer unit, and bend it as shown below.
9. Slide the printer unit in the direction indicated by the arrows so that the hooked area on the
printer unit fits into the groove on the IR-320. Make sure the cable is not hooked by the
projection on the plate.
2-58 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
10. Secure the printer unit with two screws.
11. Reattach the side cover.
Device Diagnostics Utility
It is possible to confirm the operation of a dedicated printer unit by using the Device
Diagnostics Utility.
If you turn on the power supply of the IR-320 and press the F10 key while the POST (Power On
Self Test) screen is displayed, the Device Diagnostics Utility is displayed.
TM/Drawer area
It confirms the communication speed and the status of the dedicated
printer unit.
Device Tests menu
When executing TM print test, a test printing is printed to the
dedicated printer unit.
Refer to “Device Diagnost ics Utility” of Appendix A [BIOS Functions] for the operating
method of the Device Diagnostics Utility.
Other Operating Confirmation
The operation of a dedicated printer unit can be confirmed by using the following
procedure instead of using the Device Diagnostics Utility.
1. While holding down the Paper feed switch on the upper part of the IR-320, turn on the
power supply of the IR-320.
2. The setting contents of the present printer are printed out from the dedicated printer unit.
Confirm that it is printed out correctly.
Rev. C
Setup 2-59
Confidential
Installing a PCI Board
The IR-320 has two PCI expansion slots.
PCI slots
The maximum dimensions of the applicable PCI boards are as follows:
2-60 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
CAUTION:
Before installing the PCI board, carefully confirm that it operates normally.
Follow the procedure below to install a PCI board.
CAUTION:
❏ Before setup, discharge static electricity on your body. If you do not discharge static
electricity, trouble could result. Touch a grounded metal surface to allow static
electricity to discharge.
❏ Do not touch the connectors. Dirt may cause a malfunction.
❏ Do not apply excessive force to connectors, cables, and screws during connection.
Excessive force may damage the connection parts or screw threads.
1. Remove the left side cover by sliding it downward.
2. Remove two screws from the side panel.
3. Remove the side panel.
Rev. C
Setup 2-61
Confidential
4. Remove the retaining screw securing the slot cover. Keep the screw to secure the PCI board.
Save the PCI slot cover.
5. Push the board in firmly but carefully to insert it fully. You should feel the connectors fit into
place. If the board does not go in smoothly, do not force it; pull it all the way out, and try
again.
6. Lock the PCI board with the screws removed in step 4.
7. Reattach the side panel with two screws.
8. Reattach the side cover.
When you remove the PCI board, be sure to attach a slot cover.
Installing a Customer Display
The following customer displays can be connected to the IR-320.
Model name
Specification
DM-D110/210
20 characters x 2 lines
DM-D500
256 x 64 dots (graphics mode)
32 characters x 4 lines (font A) / 42 characters x 8 lines (font B)
DM-D110
2-62 Setup
DM-D210
DM-D500
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Depending on its type, the customer display may need the optional DM-D extension unit for the
IR series (DP-504) for connection to the IR-320. Check your customer display to determine
whether it needs the extension.
fixing screws
base
support A
support B
(for extension)
Operating progress
1. Set up the Customer display with the IR-320.
2. Turn on the power supply of the IR-320 and start up the Device Diagnostics Utility.
3. Confirm that the Customer display is connected correctly and displays correctly by using
the Device diagnostics Utility.
Setup procedure
Follow the procedure below to attach a Customer display.
1. Pass the cable for the DM-D500 through support A, and attach support A to the DM-D500.
When using support B for extension, insert the tab on support B into the hole on support A
until it clicks.
when using support B for
extension
2. Attach the base to the attachment position on the IR-320.
Rev. C
Setup 2-63
Confidential
Note:
When attaching the base, note that the corners of the base are set as shown below.
3. Pass the cable for the DM-D500 through the base.
4. Install the extension on the base. Be sure that the projection on the base snaps into the hole in
the extension.
5. Connect the cable for the DM-D500 to the DM connector on the IR-320.
2-64 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
CAUTION:
❏ Detour the extra length of the cable around the power fan. If the cable interferes
with the power fan, abnormal noise may be emitted, or the cable may be
disconnected.
❏ Do not connect any cable other than the customer display cable, such as a
telephone line, to the connector for the customer display.
6. Set the DIP switch so that the baud rate of the customer display is the same as the baud rate
of the printer unit. The position of the DIP switch should be set as follows:
Note:
The customer display and the baud rate of the dedicated printer unit are set to the same speed at the factory
shipment.
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4
DM-D110
DM-D210
DM-D500
Rev. C
Setup 2-65
Confidential
For the DM-D110 and DM-D210, set SW5, SW6, and SW7 of DIP switch bank 1 (DSW1) as
indicated in the following table
SW1-5
SW1-6
SW1-7
Transfer speed (bps)
ON
ON
ON
2400
OFF
ON
ON
4800
ON
OFF
ON
9600
OFF
OFF
ON
19200
ON
ON
OFF
38400
OFF
ON
OFF
57600
ON
OFF
OFF
115200 (*1)
(*1) When using the data pass through connection (default setting), you must not set 115200 bps.
For the DM-D500, set SW6, SW7, and SW8 of DIP switch bank 1 (DSW1) as indicated in the
following table:
SW1-6
SW1-7
SW1-8
Transfer speed (bps)
ON
ON
ON
2400
OFF
ON
ON
4800
ON
OFF
ON
9600
OFF
OFF
ON
19200
ON
ON
OFF
38400
OFF
ON
OFF
57600
ON
OFF
OFF
115200
7. Cut off the portion of the customer display cover shown below. Cut off the three connecting
pieces (burrs) with a cutter.
cut this off
2-66 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Device Diagnostics Utility
By using the Device Diagnostics Utility you can confirm that the customer display is
connected correctly and displays correctly.
Device Diagnostics Utility is displayed when the power supply of the IR-320 is turned on and
then the F10 key is pressed while the POST (Power On Self Test) screen is displayed.
DM area
Confirm the communication speed and the status of the customer
display.
Device Tests menu
WhWhen executing the DM display test, the test message is
displayed in the customer display.
Refer to “Device Diagnostics Utility” in Appendix A [BIOS Functions] about the operation of
the Device Ddiagnostics Utiity.
Installing a Mouse/Keyboard
A mouse or a keyboard can be connected to the keyboard/mouse connector on the IR-320.
keyboard/mouse connector
To connect both of them, you must use a commercially available branch cable.
Rev. C
Setup 2-67
Confidential
Note:
When using a keyboard/mouse branch cable, you need to attach the mouse to the keyboard connector and
the keyboard to the mouse connector. Therefore, you connect the keyboard to the “M” connector and the
mouse to the “K” connector.
connector marked with “K”
connector marked with “M”
Installing a Cash Drawer
The cash drawer is controlled via the printer unit. If the printer unit is not connected, the cash
drawer cannot be controlled.
When a dedicated printer is connected, connect the cash drawer connector to the drawer
connector on the IR-320.
drawer connector
When another type of TM printer is connected, connect the cash drawer connector to the TM
printer drawer connector.
Note:
When a non-dedicated-type TM printer is connected, do not connect the cash drawer connector to the
drawer connector of the IR-320.
CAUTION:
Do not connect a telephone line to the DK connector.
2-68 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Attaching a Power Cable
WARNING:
❏ Never insert or disconnect the power plug with wet hands. This may result in severe
shock.
❏ Do not place multiple loads on the power outlet (wall outlet). Overloading the outlet
may lead to fire.
❏ Do not plug in the power cable if the power plug is contaminated with dust or other
foreign matter. Doing so may cause a fire.
❏ Insert the power plug fully. Failure to do so causes the power plug to heat up and
may cause a fire.
❏ Regularly remove the power plug from the outlet and clean the base of the prongs
and between the prongs. If you leave the power plug in the outlet for a long time,
dust may collect on the base of the prongs, causing a short and fire.
Follow these steps to attach the power cable:
1. Loosen the screws of the rear cover, and remove the rear cover by pulling down the upper
part of the rear cover.
2.
Connect the power cable to the IR-320. The power cable for the outlet can be connected, also.
AC inlet
AC outlet
3. Connect the power plug to the power outlet.
4. Reattach the rear cover with the screw.
Rev. C
Setup 2-69
Confidential
Installing Peripheral Devices to the COM Port
The IR-320 has four serial ports. (COM1, COM2, COM5, COM6). Also it can output +5V or +12V
at the 1st pin by the jumper setting (JP7~JP18) on the mother board.
COM5 and COM6 can be used in the default setting. Change the BIOS setting and assign
COM5 and COM6 to the IRQ not being used.
Note:
COM3 (for the dedicated printer unit / the customer display) and COM4 (for the touch panel) cannot be
used because they are set for the dedicated the IR-320.
Note:
Do not use a serial mouse.
Setup
Setting a Jumper
It can output +5V or +12V power at the 1st pin of the serial connector by the jumper setting
(JP7~JP18) on the mother board. As the DCD signal is set to output in the default and the power
supply is not output. Refer to “Chapter 1 Jumper Locations and Settings” for the jumper
setting.
CAUTION:
 ❏ Making a mistake in setting the jumpers can damage the device or cause it to heat
up and possibly cause a fire. Confirm that the jumper setting is correct before
connecting the unit.
COM5, COM6 Setting
COM5 and COM6 cannot used as the default. To use, The BIOS setting must be changed by
using the following procedure. Refer to Chapter 5 “BIOS Functions” for the datails of the BIOS.
Note:
When setting the BIOS, always connect the PS/2 keyboard. It cannot be operated from the touchpanel.
1. Connect the PS/2 keyboard to the IR-320 and turn on the power. If you press Del during the
POST, the BIOS setup utility starts.
2. Choose Integrated Peripherals and press Enter.
3. Choose Onboard Serial Port 5 and Onboard Serial Port 6 from the
Integrated Peripherals menu and then set the I/O address and the IRQ number.
2-70 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Note:
For the I/O address and the IRQ number, make the other port (the parallel port etc.)not to be used
(Disabled) and then set the I/O address and IRQ number.
4. Press Esc to return to the main menu, choose Save & Exit Setup and press Enter. The
dialog is displayed; input “Y” and press Enter.
5. The system starts up and COM5 and COM6 can be used.
6. The system starts up and COM5 and COM6 can be used.
Operating Confirmation Of The Hardware Device Diagnostics Utility
Whe using the Device Diagnostics Utility, the communication lines between the devices
connected with the IR-320 can be tested.
The Device Diagnostics Utility can test the following.
•
The connecting condition of each device
•
The printing test of the TM printer
•
The display test of the customer display
•
The operating test of the cash drawer
•
The loopback test of the serial port
•
The loopback test ot the LPT1 port
•
The printing test of the printer connected to the LPT1
Refer to the Device Diagnostics Utility in Chapter6 “Device Diagnostics Utility” for details.
Rev. C
Setup 2-71
Confidential
Printing Using Windows
It is possible to print to the dedicated printer unit of the IR-320 using Windows.
Note:
Before executing a test printout from Windows, set up the dedicated printer unit correctly and confirm the
operation using the Device Diagnostics Utility. If it does not set up correctly, the test printout from
Windows is not executed normally. Refer to “Installing a Dedicated Printer Unit” for the setup procedure
and the operating confirmation procedure of the Device Diagnostics Utility.
Operating progress
Set up the dedicated printer unit to the IR-320; confirm the operation by using
the Device Diagnostics Utility.
Refer to “Installing a Dedicated Printer Unit”
Install the APD (Advanced Printer Driver)
Setup the APD and print the status sheet of the printer using the test.
Print from Windows application using the test.
Installing procedure of APD
Install the APD using the following procedure.
1. Start up the system and execute the driver of the following folder.
C:\BACKUP\APDRV\******.EXE
2. The License Agreement dialog is displayed. Select the “I accept the terms in the License
agreement.” check box, click NEXT.
3. The Location to Save Files dialog is displayed. Choose the folder in the installation place and
click NEXT. C:\Program Files\..\EPSON Advanced Printer Driver\Setup\ are chosen in
the default.
4. The file is extracted and the Select OS dialog is displayed. Choose your OS in the Select
Install OS box. Confirm that US is chosen in Select Install Language. Click NEXT.
5. The Select Module dialog is displayed. Choose the printer driver to install. Also, choose the
overwriting condition of the file in Universal Driver Overwrite. The printer driver has the
following types. When you click Finish, the file is copied into the specified folder.
2-72 Setup
Rev. C
Confidential
Receipt
Reduce35
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
It is printed on the receipt paper without changing the character size.
It prints the print image of Windows in a reduced size: the receipt paper
size.
6. After the installation of the APD is completed, the dialog to confirm the restart of the
computer is displayed. Click Yes.
7. Restart the system.
Setting a Printer driver and test printing
Set the printer driver and test print by following the steps below.
1. Start the system and choose Setting - Printer in the start menu.
2. The Printers dialog is displayed. Confirm that the icon of the installed printer driver is
displayed.
“Ex. for the TM-T88IIR”
EPSON TM-T88II(R)Receipt
It prints at usual character size.
EPSON TM-T88II(R)Reduce35 It prints as a reduction in the receipt paper size.
3. Click the icon of the printer driver for printing and right click and choose Properties from
the menu that is displayed.
4. Click the Ports tab and choose COM3 for “Print to the following port.” Click Apply. More
than one printer driver can be set to the same port.
5. Click the General tab and click Print Test Page, and then the print of the test page starts.
Confirm that it is printed normally.
6. When the print of the test page is completed, the confirmation dialog is displayed. When it
is printed mormally, click OK and close the dialog.
Note:
When it is not printed normally, it is possibly caused by a mistake in the setup and the setting contents.
Refer to the procedure of “Installing a Dedicated Printer Unit” and “The Installation procedure of the
APD,” and then reconfirm that it is set normally.
Rev. C
Setup 2-73
Confidential
Test printing from a Windows application
The test print can be done from a Windows application. It can print a document made with the
text editor and the image data can be printed from software such as the Internet Explorer or
Paint.
Choose the printer driver to use according to the print purpose.
"Ex. For the TM-T88IIR”
EPSON TM-T88II(R)Receipt
It prints at usual character size.
EPSON TM-T88II(R)Reduce35 It prints as a reduction in the receipt paper size.
Change the printer driver to use by following the steps below.
1. Start the system and choose Setting - Printer in the start menu.
2. The Printers dialog is displayed. Confirm thet the icon of the installed printer driver is
displayed.
3. Click the icon of the printer driver for using to print and choose Set as Default Printer from
the menu that is displayed by the right click.
4. The icon of the printer driver has a check mark and it is set as the default printer.
2-74 Setup
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Chapter 3
OS and Drivers
Outline of This Chapter
This chapter tells which Operating Systems and Drivers can be used and how to install and
uninstall them.
Operating Systems
The following Operating Systems can be used for the IR-320.
❏ Windows 2000 Professional
(There is a version preinstalled by EPSON)
❏ Windows XP Professional Edition
❏ Windows 98 SE
(There is a version preinstalled by EPSON)
❏ Windows NT Workstation 4.0 SP6a
(There is a version preinstalled by EPSON)
❏ MS-DOS Ver.6.22
Drivers and Utilities
Drivers for using the IR-320 are on the Driver CD-ROM included with the IR-320. If the
operating system is pre-installed, the drivers are also installed.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-1
Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320
In case you use a locally procured OS on the IR-320, the drivers for using the peripheral devices
are on this CD-ROM.
The CD-ROM directory is shown below.
Root
|--- DOS62
|
|--- Cdrom
|
|--- Network
|
|--- Touch
|--- WIN98
|
|--- Chipset
|
|--- Dissw
|
|--- Epsbatt
|
|--- Logon
|
|--- Network
|
|--- Sound
|
|--- Touch
|
|---Video
|--- WINNT
|
|--- Logon
|
|--- Network
|
|--- Sound
|
|--- Touch
|
|---Video
|--- WIN2K
|
|--- Chipset
|
|--- Dissw
|
|--- Epsbatt
|
|--- Epserial
|
|--- Logon
|
|--- Network
|
|--- Sound
|
|--- Touch
|
|---Video
|--- WINXP
|
|--- Chipset
|
|--- Epsbatt
|
|--- Epserial
|
|--- Network
|
|--- Touch
|
|---Video
|--- COMMON
|--- OPOSADK
|--- APDRV
|--- TMDRV
|--- KEYCFG
|--- WIN
|--- DISK1
|--- DOS
3-2 OS and Drivers
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
CDVER.TAG
Drivers for MS-DOS
CD-ROM drivers
Network drivers
Touch Panel drivers
Drivers for Windows98
Chipset drivers
Power button prohibited setting tool
AC line tool
Logon tool
Network drivers
Sound drivers
Touch Panel drivers
Video drivers
Drivers for Windows NT
Logon tool
Network drivers
Sound drivers
Touch Panel drivers
Video drivers
Drivers for Windows2000
Chipset drivers
Power button prohibited setting tool
AC line tool
Serial Driver
Logon tool
Network drivers
Sound drivers
Touch Panel drivers
Video drivers
Drivers for Windows XP
Chipset drivers
AC line tool
Serial Driver
Network drivers
Touch Panel drivers
Video drivers
Common OS utility drivers
OPOS ADK
Advanced Printer driver
TM driver
DM-MS Definition tool
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Readme.txt files are in both the root directory and in subdirectories of the root directory.
1. The Readme.txt file in the root directory contains an overview of this CD-ROM and
refers to the Readme.txt files in the various subdirectories.
2. The Readme.txt files in the operating system subdirectories explain driver installation/
un-installation for each operating system.
3. Readme.txt files for KEYCFG, OPOS-ADK, and APDRV are included with the software.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-3
Windows 2000 Pre-Installed Model
The exclusive EPSON utility and drivers for using IR-320 are pre-installed in the HDD with the
pre-installed Windows 2000 Professional.
Installation Procedure
Windows 2000 Installation
When the power supply is turned on, the installation starts. Enter the product
key of the W2K label pasted on the product. You can set up the Network
automatically or set it up later.
Windows 2000 Service Pack Installation
Change of Double click settings
Set up this setting every time a new user starts using Windows 2000.
Serial Driver Installation
AC line tool Installation
When using the Battery Unit (OI-R03)
Power button prohibited setting tool Installation
Other software Installation
When using OPOS-ADK, APD (Windows printer drivers) and Unimini,
install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
3-4 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Formatting the hard disk
The hard disk is composed of one partition of up to 10 GB as a system area. For a hard disk of
more than 10 GB, the excess area other than the system area is not yet formatted. This drive can
be converted to NTFS using the Convert command. Use the disk administrator when creating a
drive in the unused area. The start-up drive has been formatted to the following file system.
•
File system: FAT32
•
Volume label: Windows 2000
Pre-installed software
❏ Microsoft Windows 2000 Professional
❏ Microsoft Windows 2000 Service Pack 3
❏ Intel Chipset software installation utility
❏ Intel Video driver
❏ Intel Network driver
❏ Analog Devices Sound driver
❏ EPSON Touch Panel driver
❏ EPSON Logon tool *1
❏ EPSON DM-MS Series setup utility *1
❏ EPSON Power button prohibited setting tool *1
❏ EPSON AC line tool *1
❏ EPSON Serial driver *1
❏ EPSON CD-ROM driver for DOS*2
Note:
*1: These are not installed during the auto installation procedure.
*2: When using the OS Recovery.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-5
Version of the Pre-installation HDD
To confirm the version of the HDD, see the file HDVER.TAG in the root directory of the boot
drive. This file is text-formatted and can be read using Notepad or a similar text editor. The file
HDVER.TAG has the following contents:
[HD Information]
MODEL=IR-320
OS=Windows2000
LANG=Dutch/English/French/German/Italian/Portuguese/Spanish
VER=1.**.*
Directory Configuration
The root directory of the HDD is structured as follows.
|--- Backup
|
|--- Keycfg
:
|
|
|--- Win
:
|
|
|
|--- Disk1 :
|
|
|--- DOS
:
|
|--- Chipset
:
|
|--- Dissw
:
|
|--- Epsbatt
:
|
|--- Epserial
:
|
|--- Logon
:
|
|--- Network
:
|
|--- Sound
:
|
|--- Touch
:
|
|--- Video
:
|
|--- Recovery
:
|
|
|--- Bootfd
:
|
|
|
|--- Data :
|--- Bootdisk
:
|--- Documents and Settings:
|--- I386
:
|--- Mui
:
|--- Program Files
:
|--- WINNT
:
Backup of MSR Utility
Backup of MSR Utility for Windows
Backup of MSR Utility for MS-DOS
Chipset driver backup folder
Power button prohibited setting tool backup folder
AC line tool backup folder
EPSON Serial driver backup folder
Logon tool backup folder
Network driver backup folder
Sound driver backup folder
Touch Panel driver backup folder
Video driver backup folder
Recovery folder
Folder for files used to create an ordinary boot floppy disk
Folder for saving text and settings.
Setup file folder
Windows utility folders
Windows folders
The I386 directory may be deleted after the addition of the Windows 2000 application and the
addition / change of the driver.
The directories under the Backup directory are the backups for drivers and utilities. Each of
these directories can be backed up into CD-R or other media. After being backed up, these
directories may be deleted.
If you install the optional CD-R/RW drive, you need to get software for CD-R/RW writing. The
software is not supplied by EPSON.
3-6 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Windows 2000 Setup Procedure
CAUTION
Be sure to keep the keyboard connected. If necessary, start the setup procedure after
connecting the mouse.
The keyboard is necessary for inputting the product ID and password. The keyboard is
also necessary for user verification during logon to Windows 2000, even if the touch
panel is in a usable state.
Windows 2000 is set up by using the following procedure.
1. Turn on the system, and boot the system from the pre-installation HDD. Windows 2000
setup will start.
2. The License Agreement screen is displayed. Check the contents, then select [I accept this
agreement] and click Next.
3. The Regional Settings screen is displayed. Make sure the system locale, user locales and
keyboard layout are set to United States, then click Next.
4. The Personalize Your Software screen is displayed. Input the Name and Organization, then
click Next.
5. The Your Product Key screen is displayed. Input the product key entered on the cover of the
First Step Guide in the COA (Certificate of Authenticity) package included with this
product; then click Next.
6. The Computer Name and Administrator Password screen is displayed. Input the Computer
Name and Administrator Password, then click Next.
7. The Date and Time Settings screen is displayed. Set the date and time, then click Next.
8. The Networking Settings screen is displayed. Select either Typical Settings or Custom
Settings according to the environment, then click Next. The Networking Components screen
is displayed if Custom Settings is selected. Set the settings in accordance with the
environment, then click Next.
9. The Workgroup or Computer Domain screen is displayed. Set the settings in accordance
with the environment, then click Next.
10. The system will start automatically when Restart is clicked.
11. The Network Identification Wizard starts. Click Next.
12. The Users of this Computer screen is displayed. Set the settings in accordance with the
environment, then click Next.
13. The Completing the Network Identification Wizard screen is displayed. Click Finish.
14. Windows 2000 starts and the setup is completed.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-7
CAUTION:
The setup is executed with the SVGA display.
Setting the recognition range of the double click
When connecting the LCD with the touch panel and making a setup, the touch panel driver is
automatically installed and the double click setting registry key of Windows is modified.
But when a new user first logs on, the default value of Windows is applied to the value of the
registry key, so the registry key must be modified for individual users.
When you set up Windows 2000 and create a new user, you have to modify the registry key for
individual users by following the steps below.
Note
The administrator modifies the registry key.
Method
Select Programs - Epson Touch Panel Tool - Touch Panel Configuration Tool from the Start
menu. Click OK. (There is no need to do any other operation.)
Various Configurations (Windows 2000)
Various configurations are executed during the setup procedure, and the keyboard and the
mouse are automatically set. To change their configurations, use the control panel.
Setting the Network
A dialog box prompting the user to manually install the network is displayed. Set the network
settings by the following procedure.
1. Open the Control Panel, then select Network and Dial-up Connections.
2. The Network and Dial-up Connections dialog box is displayed. Select Make New
Connection.
3.
The Network Connection Wizard starts. If the location information setting has not been
completed by this time, the Location Information dialog box is displayed at this time. Set the
settings in accordance with the environment, then click OK. If all the location information
has been set, this dialog box is not displayed. Proceed to item (5) and set the settings in
subsequent steps.
4. The Telephone and Modem Option dialog box is displayed. Select the location set in the
previous item, then click OK.
5. The Network Connection Wizard opening dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3-8 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
6. The Network Connection Type dialog box is displayed. Set the settings in accordance with
the environment; then click Next. The dialog displayed by the following procedure is
different depending on the type of the set network connection. The explanation here is for
the case in which Connect directly to another computer is selected. Setting of other network
connections can be accomplished in the same way by following instructions of the Network
Connection Wizard.
7. The Host or Guest dialog box is displayed. Set the settings in accordance with the
environment, then click Next. The explanation here is for the case in which Host is selected.
8.
The Connection Device dialog box is displayed. Set the settings in accordance with the
environment, then click Next.
9. The Allowed Users dialog box is displayed. Set the settings in accordance with the
environment, then click Next.
10. The Completing the Network Connection Wizard dialog box is displayed. Input the name to
be given to the current settings, then click Finish.
11. The newly set connection is added to the Network and Dial-up Connection dialog box. To
change the connection method, right click on the newly added icon, and select Properties.
The settings can then be changed.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-9
EPSON Serial Driver
When the serial port is transmitting with Windows 2000, this Driver prevents the OS from
shifting to the Standby mode, and the operation of the full-on mode can be continued.
When installing the service pack, install the serial driver again.
Install
Note
Be sure an administrator installs the serial driver.
Install the serial driver using the following procedure.
1. Execute C:\backup\epserial\Epserial.exe.
2. Start serial driver Setup. The welcome screen is displayed. Click Next.
3. After installation is completed, the InstallShield Wizard Complete dialog box is displayed.
Select Yes, I want to restart my computer now, then click Finish to restart the system.
Uninstall
Uninstall the serial driver using the following procedure.
1. Open the Control Panel and select Add/Remove Programs.
2. The Add/Remove Programs dialog box is displayed. Click Change or Remove Programs to
display a list of the currently installed programs. Change/Remove will be displayed when
EPSON Serial Driver is selected. Click Change/Remove.
3. The Confirm File Deletion dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
4. The Remove Programs From Your Computer dialog box is displayed. The uninstall process
then begins.
5. A dialog box is displayed when uninstall is completed. Click OK.
AC line tool
This tool is the utility to monitor the switching of the power of the system over to the battery
from the AC Line with Windows 2000 when the battery unit ( OI-R03 ) option is attached. For
details, see page 4-67.
Power button prohibited setting tool for windows 2000
The Power button prohibited setting tool is the tool setting the registry to prohibit the shift to the
shutdown and the stand-by mode even if the front power switch is pressed. It can prevent the
shutdown of the system even if the front power switch is pressed by mistake.
Note for using
When Power Options of Windows are updated, the setting is cleared, so always set after
updating the Power Options.
3-10 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
How to use
use
1. Execute C:\Backup\Dissw\DISSW.EXE.
2. The following message is displayed. Click Yes. If No is clicked, processing stops and you
return to Windows.
3. When setting the registry, the following message is displayed. Click Yes, so Windows is
restarted and the setting becomes valid.
If you click No, the setting returns to Windows without becoming valid. In this case, if you
then restart Windows, the setting becomes valid
Adding Windows 2000 Applications
When adding any Windows 2000 application, specify the C:\I386 directory. In this directory,
\I386 has been backed up from the Windows 2000 CD-ROM.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-11
Support Information
Right click the My Computer icon and select Properties from the pull down menu. Then the
System properties are displayed.
Click the Support information button, so the information on the contact is displayed
3-12 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Recovering the OS
Preparing confirmation
Confirm the following before OS recovery.
❏ When the CD-ROM drive (OI-R06) is connected, OS recovery can be done just as it is starting
up from the CD-ROM drive. When using the other drive, the start-up floppy disk is
necessary. Refer to the README-e.TXT file and create a start-up floppy disk.
❏ "The Windows 2000 CD-ROM " included with the product is used for recovering Windows
2000.
❏ Use the HDD included in the shipment or an unused HDD for OS recovery.
❏ The external keyboard is necessary for the recovery.
❏ After restoring the OS, a product ID must be entered at the setup of Windows. The product
ID is on the first step guide cover in the COA (Certificate of Authenticity) package attached
to the system.
❏ Set the BIOS setting to "Optimized Defaults.” When using the BIOS setting customized, note
down the BIOS setting value beforehand. After the recovery is done, you must reset it to that
value.
❏ OS recovery erases all contents of the HDD. Back up the necessary data to a floppy disk or
other media.
R ecovering method
Follow the steps below to carry out OS recovery.
1. Turn power to the IR-320 off. Turn the main power switch off. Unplug the power cable.
2. If a CD-ROM drive is not already installed, attach a drive to the IR-320.
3. Attach to the IR-320 the HDD unit you'd like to recover.
4. Connect the external keyboard to the IR-320 keyboard/mouse connector.
5. Start up the BIOS setup utility and select the Boot Sequence option from the BIOS features
setup menu. (Refer to Chapter 4 for the operating procedure of the BIOS setup utility.)
6. Select the First Boot Device from the Advanced BIOS Features setup menu, and set the First
Boot Device to “CDROM.”
7. Insert the “Windows 2000 CD-ROM 1" into the CD-ROM drive.
8. On the BIOS setup utility main menu, select “Save & Exit Setup” and press the Enter key.
The following dialog box appears.
SAVE to CMOS and EXIT (Y/N)?
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-13
9. Press [Y] and [Enter]. The system will restart and after a short time, the License Agreement
will appear.
Strike a key when ready ... _
10. When you press any key, part of the License Agreement will appear. Repeat the same
procedure until you get to the end of the License Agreement. The following message will
appear.
Recovery Start from CD-ROM.
Please type
X: [enter]
start [enter]
A:\>_
11. Enter the following from the command prompt.
A:\> x: [Enter]
X:\> start [Enter]
12. The following message will appear. Select and enter the partition size of the HDD.
Please select the system partition size.
1: 10GB (Default size)
F: Full size of HD.
Please push a key of 1 or F._
13. Select the range to format as the system area on the hard disk. Press the “1” key to select
10GB or press the “F” key to select the full size. After that, the OS recovery starts.
14. The image data exchange dialog will appear. Insert the Windows 2000 CD-ROM 2 in the
CD-ROM drive; then press the OK button.
15. When the prompt below is displayed on the screen, OS recovery work is complete.
X:\RESTORE>_
16. Eject the “Windows 2000 CD-ROM” from the CD-ROM drive.
17. Reboot and start the BIOS setup utility.
18. Return the First Boot Device in the Advanced BIOS Features setup menu to the “Floppy.”
19. On the main menu, select “Save & Exit Setup” and press Enter. The following dialog box
appears.
SAVE to CMOS and EXIT (Y/N)?
20. Press [Y] and [Enter]. The system will restart.
Limitation
❏ Recovery cannot be performed starting from a hard disk. You must perform recovery from a
CD-ROM.
3-14 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Windows NT Pre-Installed Model
The exclusive EPSON utility and drivers for using IR-320 are pre-installed in the HDD with the
pre-installed Windows NT Workstation 4.0.
Installation Procedure
Windows NT Installation
When the power supply is turned on, the installation starts. Enter the product
key of the WNT label pasted on the product. You can set up the Network
automatically or set it up later.
Other software Installation
When using OPOS-ADK, APD (Windows printer drivers) and Unimini,
install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Formatting the hard disk
The hard disk is composed of one partition of up to 4 GB as a system area. For a hard disk of
more than 4 GB, the excess area other than the system area, is not yet formatted. The start-up
drive has been formatted to the following file system.
•
File system: NTFS
•
Volume label: NTWS40
Pre-installed software
❏ Microsoft Windows NT Workstation 4.0
❏ Microsoft Windows NT Service Pack 6
❏ Microsoft Internet Explorer 6.00 Service Pack 1
❏ Microsoft Data Access Components 2.0 Service Pack 1
❏ Intel Video driver
❏ Intel Network driver
❏ Analog Devices Sound driver
❏ EPSON Touch Panel driver
❏ EPSON Logon tool *1
❏ EPSON DM-MS Series setup utility *1
❏ EPSON CD-ROM driver for DOS *2
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-15
Note:
*1: These are not installed during the auto installation procedure.
*2: When using the OS Recovery.
Version of the Pre-installation HDD
To confirm the version of the HDD, see the file HDVER.TAG in the root directory of the boot
drive. This file is text-formatted and can be read using Notepad or a similar text editor. The file
HDVER.TAG has the following contents:
[HD Information]
MODEL=IM-320
OS=WindowsNT40
LANG=Dutch/English/French/German/Italian/Portuguese/Spanish
VER=1.**.*
Directory Configuration
The root directory of the HDD is structured as follows.
|--- Backup
|
|--- Keycfg
|
|
|--- Win
|
|
|
|--- Disk1
|
|
|--- DOS
|
|--- Logon
|
|--- Network
|
|--- Sound
|
|--- Touch
|
|--- Video
|
|--- Ie6sp1
|
|--- Mdac
|
|--- Wntsp6
|
|--- Recovery
|
|--- Bootfd
|
|--- Data
|--- Drvlib
|--- I386
|--- Temp
|--- Program Files
|--- WINNT
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
Backup of MSR Utility
Backup of MSR Utility for Windows
Backup of MSR Utility for MS-DOS
Logon tool backup folder
Network driver backup folder
Sound driver backup folder
Touch Panel driver backup folder
Video driver backup folder
Internet Explorer 6.0 backup folder
MDAC2.0
Service Pack 6 backup folder
Recovery folder
Driver groups
Setup file folder
Windows utility folders
Windows folders
The I386 and Drvlib directory may be deleted after the addition of the Windows NT application
and the addition / change of the driver.
3-16 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
The directories under the Backup directory are the backups for drivers and utilities. Each of
these directories can be backed up into CD-R or other media. After being backed up, these
directories may be deleted.
If you install the optional CD-R/RW drive, you need to get software for CD-R/RW writing. The
software is not supplied by EPSON.
Windows NT Setup Procedure
CAUTION
Because the touch panel is not operative during the setup procedure, be sure to keep
the keyboard connected. If necessary, start the setup procedure after connecting the
mouse, and the branch cable. The keyboard is necessary for inputting the product ID.
Even when the touch panel is operative, the keyboard is also necessary for starting up
the Logon process and for authorizing the user through the key operation of
CTRL+ALT+DEL.
Windows NT is set up by using the following procedure.
1. Turn on the system, and boot the system from the pre-installation HDD. Windows NT setup
will start.
2. The Windows NT Setup dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The License Agreement dialog box is displayed. Check the contents, then select [I accept this
agreement] and click Next.
4. The Name and Organization dialog box is displayed. Input the Name and Organization,
then click Next.
5. The Registration dialog box is displayed. Input the product key entered on the cover of the
First Step Guide in the COA (Certificate of Authenticity) package included with this
product; then click Next.
6. The Computer Name dialog box is displayed. Input the Computer Name, then click Next.
7. The Administrator Account dialog box is displayed. Input the Password and Confirm
Password, then click Next.
8. The Windows NT Setup dialog box is displayed. Click Finish.
9. The system will restart automatically.
10. Windows NT starts and the setup is completed.
CAUTION:
The setup is executed with the SVGA display.
Adding the Windows NT Applications
When adding any Windows NT application, specify the C:\I386 directory. In this directory,
\I386 has been backed up from the Windows NT CD-ROM.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-17
Support Information
Right click the My Computer icon and select Properties from the pull down menu. Then the
System properties are displayed.
Click the Support information button, so the information on the contact is displayed
3-18 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Recovering the OS
Preparing recovery media
❏ Preparing a start-up disk
1. Start the command prompt.
2. Go to the C:\backup\recovery\bootfd directory.
3. Execute MKDISK.bat.
4. Insert a floppy disk in the FDD.
5. Press Enter to start formatting.
6. A message asking whether you are going to format another floppy disk is displayed.
Press N and Enter.
Enter Then the necessary files are copied onto the floppy disk.
7. A message that the copying is over is displayed. Then exit command prompt.
❏ Saving the HD image data
Save all data under the C:\backup\recovery\data directory onto another medium or drive.
Example:
1. Connect the IR-320 in network to a PC that can write data onto CD-Rs.
2. Save all data under the C:\backup\recovery\data directory of the IR-320 onto the PC.
3. Write all data saved in step 2 onto a CD-R.
4. After saving the data, the directory under the C:\backup\recovery directory may be
deleted.
❏ Backing up each driver
Each directory under the C:\backup directory is the backup of each driver, which can be
backed up through individual saving.
Recovering method
❏ Editing the start-up disk
Edit CONFIG.SYS and AUTOEXE.BAT created in “Preparing a Recovery Medium” to the
device on which the image data has been saved.
❏ Recovering
1. Connect the medium or drive onto which the data has been saved in “Preparing a
Recovery Medium” to the IR-320.
2. Start the system by using the start-up floppy disk created in “Preparing a Recovery
Medium.”
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-19
3. Enter the following from the command prompt. (x: Drive with the image file) After that,
the OS recovery starts.
A:\>
x: [Enter]
start [Enter]
4. Following the title “EasyRestore,” the EPSON Logo Startup screen is displayed. Select
Continue.
5. After the OS is recovered, set up the OS.
6. Return the printer driver for OPOS and Windows saved in “Preparing a Recovery
Medium.”
Restrictions
❏ The size of the image data to be saved amounts to 500–600 MB. Saving this much data
requires a large-capacity device, such as a CD-R, MO, or server.
❏ Because of restrictions by EasyRestore, the HD image data file (HDIMG003.PQI) cannot be
divided.
❏ Because EasyRestore runs only on MS-DOS, it is a requirement of “Saving of HD Image
Data” that MS-DOS can recognize the saving destination device.
❏ When startup is initiated from the built-in hard disk of the IR-320, recovery is impossible.
3-20 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Windows 98 Pre-Installed Model
The HDD pre-installed with Windows 98 Second Edition is also pre-installed with the EPSON
utility software and drivers dedicated to the IR-320.
Languages are English, French, German, Spanish, and Italian.
Installation Procedure
Windows 98 Installation
When the power supply is turned on, the installation starts. Enter the product
key of the W98 label pasted on the product. You can set up the Network
automatically or set it up later.
Other software Installation
When using OPOS-ADK, APD (Windows printer drivers) and Unimini,
install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Formatting the hard disk
The hard disk is composed of one partition of up to 10 GB as a system area. For a hard disk of
more than 10 GB, the excess area other than the system area is not yet formatted. Use the FDISK
and FORMAT command when creating a drive in the unused area. The start-up drive has been
formatted to the following file system.
•
File system: FAT32
•
Volume label: Windows 98
Pre-installed software
❏ Microsoft Windows 98 Second Edition
❏ Intel Chipset software installation utility
❏ Intel Video driver
❏ Intel Network driver
❏ Analog Devices Sound driver
❏ EPSON Touch Panel Driver
❏ EPSON DM-MS Series setup utility *1
❏ EPSON CD-ROM driver *2
❏ EPSON Logon tool *1
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-21
❏ EPSON Power button prohibited setting tool *1
❏ EPSON AC line tool *1
Note:
*1: These are not installed during the auto installation procedure.
*2: The driver to use for OS recovery for DOS.
Version of the pre-installation HDD
To confirm the version of the HDD, see HDVER.TAG in the start-up drive root. This file is textformatted and can be read using Notepad or a similar text editor. The contents of HDVER.TAG
are as follows:
[HD Information]
MODEL=IR-320
OS= Windows98
LANG=English
VER=1.**.*
Directory Configuration
The root directory of the HDD is structured as follows:
|--- Program Files
|--- Backup
|
|--- Keycfg
|
|
|--- Win
|
|
|
|--- Disk1
|
|
|--- DOS
|
|--- Chipset
|
|--- Dissw
|
|--- Epsbatt
|
|--- Logon
|
|--- Network
|
|--- Sound
|
|--- Touch
|
|--- Video
|
|--- Recovery
|
|--- Data
|
|
|--- Restore
|
|--- Bootfd
|
|--- Data
|--- My Documents
|--- Windows
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
Application for the standard installation of Windows 98
Backup of MSR Utility
Backup of MSR Utility for Windows
Backup of MSR Utility for MS-DOS
Backup of Chipset driver
Power button prohibited setting tool backup folder
AC line tool backup folder
Backup of Logon tool
Backup of Network Driver
Backup of Sound Driver
Backup of Touch Panel Driver
Backup of Display Driver
Backup of HD (for creating Recovery Media)
EasyRestore
Start-up FD
Data of Start-up FD
Windows 98 Second Edition system
The directories under the Backup directory are the backups for drivers and utilities. Each of
these directories can be backed up onto CD-R or other media. After backup, the directories
under the Backup directory may be deleted.
3-22 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Windows 98 Set-Up Procedure
Windows 98 is set up by using the following procedure:
1. Connect the keyboard and mouse to the IR-320.
2. Turn on the PC to start Windows 98 SE.
3. The Enter Network Password dialog box is displayed. Input the password and click OK.
4. The Welcome screen is displayed. Input the necessary information and click Next.
5. The Windows End User license Agreement is displayed. Read it though and confirm your
agreement to the terms. And then select [I accept this agreement] and click Next to proceed.
6. The Windows Product Key screen is displayed. Input the 25-digit product key shown on the
COA (Certificate of Authenticity). Click Next to begin setup. If you enter an incorrect key, a
message is displayed indicating that. Select [Re-enter valid product key] and then click Next
to return to the Windows Protect Key screen and input the product key again.
7. When setup is completed, the Congratulations screen is displayed. Click Finish.
8. The system asks you to set the Date and Time properties. Check the properties displayed,
and change them as needed. Click Close to confirm the settings.
9. The system setting is automatically updated, the system is rebooted, and the Windows 98 SE
desktop appears.
Support Information
Select the My Computer icon on the desktop, click the right mouse button and select Properties
from the pull down menu.
Click the Support Information button; the information on the contact is displayed.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-23
Recovering the OS
Preparing recovery media
❏ Preparing a start-up disk
1. Start the MS-DOS Prompt.
2. Go to the C:\backup\recovery\bootfd directory.
3. Execute MKDISK.bat.
4. Insert a floppy disk in the FDD.
5. Press Enter to start formatting.
6. A message asking whether you are going to format another floppy disk is displayed.
Press N and Enter.
Enter Then the necessary files are copied onto the floppy disk.
7. A message that the copying is over is displayed. Then exit MS-DOS Prompt.
❏ Saving the HD image data
Save all data under the C:\backup\recovery\data directory onto another medium or drive.
Example:
1. Connect the IR-320 in network to a PC that can write data onto CD-Rs.
2. Save all data under the C:\backup\recovery\data directory of the IR-320 onto the PC.
3. Write all data saved in step 2 onto a CD-R.
4. After saving the data, the directory under the C:\backup\recovery directory may be
deleted.
❏ Backing up each driver
Each directory under the C:\backup directory is the backup of each driver, which can be
backed up through individual saving.
Recovering method
❏ Editing the start-up disk
Edit CONFIG.SYS and AUTOEXE.BAT created in “Preparing a Recovery Medium” to the
device on which the image data has been saved.
❏ Recovering
1. Connect the medium or drive onto which the data has been saved in “Preparing a
Recovery Medium” to the IR-320.
2. Start the system by using the start-up floppy disk created in “Preparing a Recovery
Medium.”
3-24 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
3. Enter the following from the command prompt. (x: Drive with the image file) After that,
the OS recovery starts.
A:\>
x: [Enter]
start [Enter]
4. The following message appears. Select and enter the partition size of the HDD.
Please select the system partition size.
1: 10GB (Default size)
F: Full size of HD.
Please push a key of 1 or F._
5. Select the range to format as the system area on the hard disk. Press the “1” key to select
10GB or press the “F” key to select the full size. After that, the OS recovery starts.
6. Following the title “EasyRestore,” the EPSON Logo Startup screen is displayed. Select
Continue.
7. After the OS is recovered, set up the OS.
8. Return the printer driver for OPOS and Windows saved in “Preparing a Recovery
Medium.”
Restrictions
❏ The size of the image data to be saved amounts to 500–600 MB. Saving this much data
requires a large-capacity device, such as a CD-R, MO, or server.
❏ Because of restrictions of EasyRestore, the HD image data file (HDIMG003.PQI) cannot be
divided.
❏ Because EasyRestore runs only on MS-DOS, it is a requirement of “Saving of HD Image
Data” that MS-DOS can recognize the saving destination device.
❏ When startup is initiated from the built-in hard disk of the IR-320, recovery is impossible.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-25
Installation for Windows XP Professional Locally Procured Edition
Installation Procedure
If you install Windows XP Professional locally procured edition, follow the steps below.
Windows XP Professional Installation
Insert the Windows XP startup disk and CD-ROM; then turn on the IR-320 to
perform the setup. Enter the product key of the COA package. You can set up
the Network automatically or set it up later.
Video Driver Installation
Install theVideo Driver from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Chipset Driver Installation
Install the Chipset Driver from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Network Driver Installation
Install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Touch Panel Driver Installation
Install the Touch Panel Driver from the CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Serial port Driver Installation
Install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
AC line tool Installation
When using the Battery Unit (OI-R03), install the software from the Driver
CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Other software Installation
When using OPOS-ADK, APD (Windows printer drivers) and Unimini,
install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
3-26 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Setup procedure
Windows XP is set up by using the following procedure:
1. Connect the keyboard and mouse to the IR-320.
2. Insert the CD-ROM of Windows XP in the CD-ROM drive and boot up the system.
3. The [Welcome to Setup] screen is displayed. Press [Enter].
4. The [END-USER LICENSE AGREEMENT] screen is displayed. Read it through and confirm
contents. If you agree with them, press the [F8] key.
5. Select the partition to set up Windows, and press [Enter]. When an unformatted partition is
selected, a confirmation screen is displayed. Execute the format according to the instructions
on the screen. After that, copying of the file starts.
6. Reboot the system again according to the instructions on the screen.
Video Driver Installation Method
7. Start COMMAND PROMPT by pressing [Shift + F10] in the “Locale Setting.“
8. Change the CD-ROM.
Eject the CD-ROM of Windows XP, and Insert the Driver CD-ROM of IR-320.
9. Execute WinXP\Video\WIN2K_XPE67.EXE in the Driver CD-ROM of IR-320.
10. The Release note is displayed. Click Next.
11. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
12. The License Agreement dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
13. Installing is completed and the reboot dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [No, I will
restart my computer later] is selected, and click Finish.
14. Finish the COMMAND PROMPT using [“Exit“ + Enter].
15. Change the CD-ROM.
Eject the Driver CD-ROM of IR-320.
Insert the CD-ROM of Windows XP.
Video Driver Install End
16. The [Regional and Language Options] dialog box is displayed. Confirm the setting contents
and click Next.
Next
17. The [Personalize Your Software] dialog box is displayed. Input your name and your
organization, and then click Next.
Next
18. The [Your Product key] dialog box is displayed. Input the 25-digit product key shown on the
COA (Certificate of Authenticity) and click Next.
Next
19. The [Computer Name and Administrator Password] dialog box is displayed. Input the
necessary information and click Next.
Next
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-27
20. The [Date and Time Settings] dialog box is displayed. Confirm the setting and click Next.
Next
21. The system reboots automatically.
22. The [Welcome to Microsoft Windows] dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
Next
23. The [Who will use this computer ?] dialog box is displayed. Input the user name according
to the instruction on the screen.
24. The [Thank you!] dialog box is displayed. Click Finish;
Finish Windows XP will start.
CAUTION:
Setup is executed with the VGA display.
Installing the Intel Chipset Diver
Note
The Chipset Driver must be installed before you install other drivers
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
WinXP\Chipset\infinst_enu.EXE.
2. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome screen is displayed. Click Next.
3. The License Agreement screen is displayed. Click Yes.
4. The Readme Information dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
5. Complete dialog box is displayed. Click Finish.
Uninstalling the Intel chipset driver
Uninstalling cannot be done.
Installing the Network Driver
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
WinXP\Network\pro2kxpm.exe.
2. The Setup Wizard starts, and the License Agreement dialog box is displayed. Select [I accept
the terms in the license agreement] and click Next.
3. The Location to Save Files dialog box is displayed. Input the folder and click Next. The
default setting is C:\IntelPRO.
4. When copying of the file is completed, the Complete dialog box is displayed. Click Install
now.
3-28 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
5. The Complete dialog box is displayed. Click Finish.
Uninstalling the network driver
To uninstall the Network Driver using the following procedure.
1. Open the Control Panel, and select Add or Remove Programs.
2. The Add or Remove Programs dialog box is displayed. Click Change or Remove Programs
to display a list of the currently installed programs. Change/Remove will be displayed
when Intel(R) PRO Ethernet Adapter and Software is selected. Click Change/Remove.
3. The Intel(R) PRO Adapters and Software Uninstaller dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
Installing the Touch Panel Driver
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
WinXP\Touch\EPSTPWDM.EXE.
2. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The Choose Destination Location dialog box is displayed. Input the folder and click Next.
The default setting is C:\Program Files\EPSON\TouchPanel.
4. The Hardware Installation dialog box is displayed. Click Continue Anyway.
5. The Setup Complete dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my
computer now] is selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
Uninstalling the touch panel driver
Uninstall the Touch Panel Driver using the following procedure.
1. Open the Control Panel, and select Add or Remove Programs.
2. The Add or Remove Programs dialog box is displayed. Click Change or Remove Programs
to display a list of the currently installed programs. Change/Remove will be displayed
when EPSON Touch Panel Driver is selected. Click Change/Remove.
3. The Confirm File Deletion dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
4. The reboot dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
5. Uninstalling is completed and the dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
Installing the Serial Port Driver
When the serial port is transmitting with Windows XP, this Driver prevents the OS from shifting
to the Standby mode and the operation of the full-on mode is continued.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-29
Note
Be sure an administrator installs the serial driver.
Install the serial port driver using the following procedure.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
WinXP\Epserial\EPSERIAL.EXE.
2. Start serial driver Setup. The welcome screen is displayed. Click Next.
3. After installation is completed, the InstallShield Wizard Complete dialog box is displayed.
Select Yes, I want to restart my computer now, then click Finish to restart the system.
Uninstalling the serial port driver
Uninstall the serial port driver using the following procedure.
1. Open the Control Panel, and select Add or Remove Programs.
2. The Add or Remove Programs dialog box is displayed. Click Change or Remove Programs
to display a list of the currently installed programs. Change/Remove will be displayed
when EPSON Serial Driver is selected. Click Change/Remove.
3. The Confirm File Deletion dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
Installing the AC line tool
This tool is the utility to monitor the switching of the power of the system over to the battery
from the AC Line with Windows 2000 when the battery unit ( OI-R03 ) option is attached. For
details, see page 4-67.
Install the AC Line tool using the following procedure.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
WinXP\Epsbatt\EPSBATT.EXE.
2. The Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The Complete dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my computer
now] is selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
Uninstalling the AC line tool
Uninstall the AC Line tool using the following procedure.
1. Open the Control Panel, and select Add or Remove Programs.
2. The Add or Remove Programs dialog box is displayed. Click Change or Remove Programs
to display a list of the currently installed programs. Change/Remove will be displayed
when EPSON AC Line watching is selected. Click Change/Remove.
3. The Confirm File Deletion dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
3-30 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Installation for Windows 2000 Professional Locally Procured Edition
Installation Procedure
If you install Windows 2000 Professional locally procured edition, follow the steps below.
Windows 2000 Professional Installation
Insert the Windows 2000 startup disk and CD-ROM; then turn on the IR-320
to perform the setup. Enter the product key of the COA package. You can set
up the Network automatically or set it up later.
Video Driver Installation
Install the Video Driver from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320
Chipset Driver Installation
Install the Chipset Driver from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Network Driver Installation
Sound Driver Installation
Install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Windows 2000 Service Pack Installation
Install the Service Pack from the CD-ROM for the Windows 2000.
Touch Panel Driver Installation
Install the Touch Panel Driver from the CD-ROM for the IR-320.
The double click setting
Set up this setting every time a new user starts using Windows 2000.
Serial port Driver Installation
Install the Serial port Driver from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-31
AC line tool Installation
When using the Battery Unit (OI-R03), install the software from the Driver
CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Power button prohibited setting tool Installation
Install the Power button prohibited setting tool from the Driver CD-ROM for
the IR-320.
Other software Installation
When using OPOS-ADK, APD (Windows printer drivers) and Unimini,
install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Setup procedure
Note
If you set up Windows 2000 on your IR-320, the system stops displaying to the LCD panel at the time of
rebooting after all setup has been done. This is because the video driver supplied together with the
Windows 2000 CD does not support the internal LCD interface.
To avoid this phenomenon please install Windows 2000 and the video driver by using the following
instructions:
Windows 2000 is set up by using the following procedure:
1. Connect the keyboard and mouse to the IR-320.
2. Insert the CD-ROM of Windows 2000 in the CD-ROM drive and boot up the system.
3. The Setup Wizard starts, and the Welcome dialog box is displayed. Press [Enter].
4. The License Agreement is displayed. Read it through and confirm your agreement to the
terms. And then press the [F8] key (I agree).
5. Input the necessary information and continue the installation according to the instructions
on the screen.
6. When copying of the file is completed, reboot the system again according to the instructions
on the screen.
3-32 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Video Driver Installation Method
1. Start COMMAND PROMPT by pressing [Shift + F10] in the “Locale Setting.“
2. Change the CD-ROM.
Eject the CD-ROM of Windows 2000 and Insert the Driver CD-ROM of IR-320.
3. Execute Win2k\Video\WIN2K_XPE67.EXE in the Driver CD-ROM of IR-320.
4. The Release note is displayed. Click Next.
5. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
6. The License Agreement dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
7. Installing is completed and the reboot dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [No, I will
restart my computer later] is selected, and click Finish.
8. Finish the COMMAND PROMPT using [“Exit“+ Enter].
9. Change the CD-ROM.
Eject the Driver CD-ROM of IR-320.
Insert the CD-ROM of Windows 2000.
Video Driver Install End
1. The Windows 2000 Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click
Next.
2. Input the necessary information and continue the installation according to the instructions
on the screen.
3. The Your Product Key screen is displayed. Input the 25-digit product key shown on the
COA (Certificate of Authenticity). Click Next to begin setup.
4. Input the necessary information and continue the installation according to the instructions
on the screen.
5. When the installation is completed, click Finish according to the instructions on the screen.
6. After the system is rebooted, the Network Identification wizard is started. Click Next.
7. Set the Password according to the instructions on the screen.
8. The installation is completed, and the desktop screen of Windows 2000 is displayed.
CAUTION:
Setup is executed with the VGA display.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-33
Installing the Intel Chipset Diver
Note
The Chipset Driver must be installed before you install other drivers.
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Win2K\Chipset\infinst_enu.EXE.
2. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome screen is displayed. Click Next.
3. The License Agreement screen is displayed. Click Yes.
4. The Readme Information dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
5. Complete dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my computer now] is
selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
Uninstalling the Intel chipset driver
Uninstalling cannot be done.
Installing the Network Driver
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Win2K\Network\pro2kxpm.exe.
2. The Setup Wizard starts, and the License Agreement dialog box is displayed. Select [I accept
the terms in the license agreement] and click Next.
3. The Location to Save Files dialog box is displayed. Input the folder and click Next. The
default setting is C:\IntelPRO.
4. When copying of the file is completed, the following dialog box is displayed. Click Install
now.
3-34 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
5. The following dialog box is displayed. Click Finish.
Uninstalling the network driver
To uninstall the Network Driver use the following procedure:
1. Open the Control Panel, and select Add/Remove Programs.
2. The Add/Remove Programs dialog box is displayed. Click Change or Remove Programs to
display a list of the currently installed programs. Change/Remove will be displayed when
Intel(R) PRO Ethernet Adapter and Software is selected. Click Change/Remove.
3. The Intel(R) PRO Adapters and Software Uninstaller dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
Installing the Sound Driver
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Win2K\Sound\SETUP.EXE.
2. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The Digital Signature Not Found dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
4. The reboot dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my computer now] is
selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
Uninstalling the sound driver
Uninstall the Sound Driver using the following procedure.
1. Open the Control Panel, and select Add/Remove Programs.
2. The Add/Remove Programs dialog box is displayed. Click Change or Remove Programs to
display a list of the currently installed programs. Change/Remove will be displayed when
Sound MAX is selected. Click Change/Remove.
3. The Sound MAX Install dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Remove all] is selected, and
click Next.
4. The reboot dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my computer now] is
selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-35
Installing the Touch Panel Driver
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Win2K\Touch\EPSTPWDM.EXE.
2. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The Choose Destination Location dialog box is displayed. Input the folder and click Next.
The default setting is C:\Program Files\EPSON\TouchPanel.
4. The Digital Signature Not Found dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
5. The Setup Complete dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my
computer now] is selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
Uninstalling the touch panel driver
Uninstall the Touch Panel Driver using the following procedure.
1. Open the Control Panel, and select Add/Remove Programs.
2. The Add/Remove Programs dialog box is displayed. Click Change or Remove Programs to
display a list of the currently installed programs. Change/Remove will be displayed when
EPSON Touch Panel Driver is selected. Click Change/Remove.
3. The Confirm File Deletion dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
4. The reboot dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
5. Uninstalling is completed and the dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
Setting the recognition range of the double click
When connecting the LCD with the touch panel and making a setup, the touch panel driver is
automatically installed and the double click setting registry key of Windows is modified.
But when a new user first logs on, the default value of Windows is applied to the value of the
registry key, so the registry key must be modified for individual users.
When you set up Windows 2000 and create a new user, you have to modify the registry key for
individual users by following the steps below.
Note
The administrator does the modification of the registry key.
Method
Select Programs - Epson Touch Panel Tool - Touch Panel Configuration Tool from the Start
menu. Click OK. (There is no need to do any other operation.)
3-36 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Installing the Serial Port Driver
When the serial port is transmitting with Windows 2000, this Driver prevents the OS from
shifting to the Standby mode and the operation of the full-on mode is continued.
When installing the service pack, install the serial driver again.
Note
Be sure an administrator installs the serial driver.
Install the serial port driver using the following procedure.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Win2K\Epserial\EPSERIAL.EXE.
2. Start serial driver Setup. The welcome screen is displayed. Click Next.
3. After installation is completed, the InstallShield Wizard Complete dialog box is displayed.
Select Yes, I want to restart my computer now; then click Finish to restart the system.
Uninstalling the serial port driver
Uninstall the serial port driver using the following procedure.
1. Open the Control Panel, and select Add/Remove Programs.
2. The Add/Remove Programs dialog box is displayed. Click Change or Remove Programs to
display a list of the currently installed programs. Change/Remove will be displayed when
EPSON Serial Driver is selected. Click Change/Remove.
3. The Confirm File Deletion dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
Installing the AC line tool
This tool is the utility to monitor the switching of the power of the system over to the battery
from the AC Line with Windows 2000 when the battery unit ( OI-R03 ) option is attached. For
details, see page 4-67.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-37
Install the AC line tool using the following procedure.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Win2K\Epsbatt\EPSBATT.EXE.
2. The Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The Complete dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my computer
now] is selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
Uninstalling the AC line tool
Uninstall the AC line tool using the following procedure.
1. Open the Control Panel, and select Add/Remove Programs.
2. The Add/Remove Programs dialog box is displayed. Click Change or Remove Programs to
display a list of the currently installed programs. Change/Remove will be displayed when
EPSON AC Line watching is selected. Click Change/Remove.
3. The Confirm File Deletion dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
Power button prohibited setting tool for windows 2000
The Power button prohibited setting tool is the tool setting the registry to prohibit the shift to the
shutdown and the stand-by mode even if the front power switch is pressed. It can prevent the
shutdown of the system even if the front power switch is pressed by mistake.
Note on using
When Power Options of Windows are updated, the setting is cleared, so always set after
updating the Power Options.
How to use
use
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Win2K\Dissw\DISSW.EXE.
2. The following message is displayed. Click Yes. If No is clicked, the installation stops
processing and returns you to Windows.
3-38 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
3. When setting the registry, the following message is displayed. Click Yes, so Windows is
restarted and the setting becomes valid.
When click No, the setting returns to Windows without becoming valid. In this case, if
restarting Windows, the setting becomes valid.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-39
Installation for Windows NT Locally Procured Edition
Note
If you use Windows NT, you need to install Service Pack 6a.
Installation Procedure
If you install Windows NT Local procured edition, follow the steps below.
Operating System Installation
Insert the CD-ROM for Windows NT and turn on the IR-320 to perform the
setup. Enter the product key of the COA package. You can set up the Network
automatically or set it up later.
Network Driver Installation
Install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Service Pack 6a Installation
Obtain Service Pack 6a and install it.
Set the HDD to the DMA mode by using Service pack 6a.
VIDEO Driver Installation
Sound Driver Installation
Touch Panel Driver Installation
Install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Other software Installation
When using OPOS-ADK, APD (Windows printer drivers) and Unimini,
install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Setup procedure
Windows NT is set up by using the following procedure:
1. Connect the keyboard and mouse to the IR-320.
2. Insert the CD-ROM of Windows NT in the CD-ROM drive and boot up the system.
3. The Welcome to Setup screen dialog box is displayed. Press the Enter key.
4. According to the instructions on the screen, input the necessary items and continue
installing.
5. The Windows NT Licensing Agreement dialog box is displayed. Press the PageDown key
and confirm contents to the last page. Press the F8 (I agree) key.
3-40 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
6. According to the instructions on the screen, input the necessary items and continue
installing.
7. When copying of the file is completed, according to the instructions on the screen, take the
Windows NT CD-ROM out of the CD-ROM drive, and then boot the system from the HDD.
8. The Windows NT Setup Wizard starts. According to the instructions on the screen, insert the
CD-ROM of Windows NT into the CD-ROM drive again and click OK.
9. According to the instructions on the screen, input the necessary items and continue
installing.
10. The Registration dialog box is displayed. Input the 10-digit CD key shown on the COA
(Certificate of Authenticity). Select Next to begin setup.
11. According to the instructions on the screen, input the necessary items and continue
installing.
12. According to the instructions on the screen, set up the date/time and the display.
13. When installing is completed, according to the instructions on the screen, take the Windows
NT CD-ROM out of the CD-ROM drive, and then click Restart Computer to reboot the
system. The desktop screen of Windows NT is displayed.
CAUTION:
Setup is executed with the VGA display.
Installing the Network Driver
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Winnt\Network\PRONT4.EXE.
2. The Setup Wizard starts and the License Agreement dialog box is displayed. Select [I accept
the terms in the license agreement] and click Next.
3. The Location to Save Files dialog box is displayed. Input the folder and click Next. The
default setting is C:\IntelPRO.
4. Open the Control Panel, and select Network. A dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
5. The Network Setup Wizard starts. Check the [Wired to the Network] check box, and click
Next.
6. Click Select from list.
7. Click Have Disk.
8. The Insert Disk dialog box is displayed. Input the directory specified by step 3, and click OK.
The default setting is C:\IntelPRO.
9. The Select OEM option dialog box is displayed. Select the [Intel(R) PRO/100 Family
Adapter] , and click OK.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-41
10. The [Intel(R) PRO/100 Family Adapter] is added to the network adapter. Click Next.
11. Select the network protocol. Set it to your system. Then click Next.
12. Select the network service. Set it to your system. Then click Next.
13. The confirm dialog box is displayed. When Next is clicked, installation starts.
14. The dialog box that specifies the directory of the copy origin is displayed. Insert the
CD-ROM of Windows NT in the CD-ROM drive and input D:\ (if the CD-ROM drive is the
D drive) and click OK.
15. In accordance with the environment used, continue the installation according to the
instructions on the screen.
16. When installing is completed, according to the instructions on the screen, reboot the system.
CAUTION:
If the network is installed after the setup, an error is caused in the logon procedure. After
installing the network driver, install Service Pack 6a.
Uninstalling the network driver
Uninstalling cannot be done.Uninstalling cannot be done.
Installing Service Pack 6a
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Service Pack 6a CD-ROM in the CD-ROM drive. Execute the
“Nt4sp6\Sp6i386.exe” on the Service Pack 6a CD-ROM.
2. The Setup Wizard starts, the License Agreement dialog box is displayed. Select [Accept the
license agreement] and click Install.
3. Installing is completed; then the dialog box is displayed. Click Restart.
Ultra DMA Setting for the HDD
You can set the HDD to the DMA mode by following the steps below.
1. Set the Service Pack 6a CD-ROM to the CD-ROM drive. Execute the
“Nt4sp6\Support\Utils\I386\Dmacheck.exe” in the Service Pack 6a CD-ROM.
3-42 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
2. ATAPI DMA Support dialog box appears. Set the DMA Detection Status of the Current
DMA Usage Channel 0 to enabled and click OK.
3. A warning dialog box appears. Click Y es.
4. A finished dialog box appears. Click OK.
5. The system reboots.
Installing the Video Driver
Note
Before installing the display driver, be sure to install Service Pack 6a.
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Set the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 to the CD-ROM drive. Start
Winnt\Video\Winnt4E67.EXE.
2. The Release note is displayed. Click Next.
3. The Setup Wizard starts. The Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
4. The License Agreement dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-43
5. Installing is completed and the InstallShield Wizard Complete dialog box is displayed.
Confirm that the [Yes, I want to restart my computer now] is selected, and click Finish to
reboot the system.
Uninstalling the video driver
Uninstalling cannot be done.
Installing the Sound Driver
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Winnt\Sound\SETUP.EXE.
2. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The About SoundMAX Integrated Digital Audio dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
4. The Setup Complete dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my
computer now] is selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
Uninstalling the sound driver
1. Select [Start Menu] - [Settings] and open the control panel.
2. Select [Add/Remove Programs] in the control panel.
3. Select [SoundMAX NT].
4. Click Add/Remove.
5. The Confirm File Deletion dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
6. Uninstalling is completed and the dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
7. The reboot dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
8. Reboot the system.
Installing the Touch Panel Driver
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Winnt\Touch\EPSTPNT.EXE.
2. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The Choose Destination Location dialog box is displayed. Input the folder and click Next.
The default setting is C:\Program Files\EPSON\TouchPanel.
4. The Setup Complete dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my
computer now] is selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
3-44 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Uninstalling the Touch Panel driver
1. Select [Start Menu] - [Settings] and open the control panel.
2. Select [Add/Remove Programs] in the control panel.
3. Select [EPSON Touch Panel Driver].
4. Click Add/Remove.
5. The Confirm File Deletion dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
6. The reboot dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
7. Uninstalling is completed and the dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-45
Installation for Windows 98 Locally Procured Edition
Installation Procedure
If you install a Windows 98 Locally procured edition, follow the steps below
Windows 98 Installation
Insert the MS-DOS startup disk and CD-ROM for Windows 98 and turn on
the IR-320 to perform the setup. Enter the product key of the COA package.
You can set up the Network automatically or set it up later.
Chipset Driver Installation
Install using the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Ultra DMA Setting for the HDD
Set the HDD to the DMA mode with OS.
Network Driver Installation
VIDEO Driver Installation
Sound Driver Installation
Touch Panel Driver Installation
Install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
AC line tool Installation
When using the Battery Unit (OI-R03), install the software from the Driver
CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Power button prohibited setting tool Installation
Other software Installation
When using OPOS-ADK, APD (Windows printer drivers) and Unimini,
install the software from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
3-46 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Setup Procedure
Windows 98 is set up by using the following procedure:
1. Connect the keyboard and mouse to the IR-320.
2. Insert the Startup disk of the MS-DOS in the FDD. Turn on the power supply to the system.
3. Insert the CD-ROM of Windows 98 in the CD-ROM drive and start SETUP.EXE. The Setup
Wizard starts.
4. The License Agreement is displayed. Read it through and confirm your agreement to the
terms. And then select [I accept the agreement] and select Next to proceed.
5.
The Windows Product Key screen is displayed. Input the 25-digit product key shown on the
COA (Certificate of Authenticity). Select Next to begin setup. If you enter an incorrect key, a
message is displayed indicating that. Select Re-enter valid product key and then select Next
to return to the Windows Protect Key screen ad input the product key again.
6. According to the instructions on the screen, input the necessary items and continue
installing.
7. When copying of the file is completed, take the Setup disk of the MS-DOS out of the FDD,
and then according to the instructions on the screen, reboot the system.
8. After rebooting the system, according to the instructions on the screen, set up the Network
and the Date/Time.
9. According to the instructions on the screen, reboot the system.
10. Drivers for the system are installed by Plug and Play. According to the instructions on the
screen, input the necessary items and continue installing.
11. When installing is completed, and according to the instructions on the screen, reboot the
system. The desktop screen is displayed.
CAUTION:
Setup is executed with the VGA display.
Installing the Chipset Driver for Intel
Note
The Chipset Driver must be installed before installing other drivers.
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive and start
\Win98\Chipset\infinst_enu.exe.
2. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome screen is displayed. Click Next.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-47
3. The License Agreement screen is displayed. Click Yes.
4. The Readme Information dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
5. The Reboot dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my computer now]
is selected, and click Finish.
6. After the system is restarted, the Chipset drivers are installed.
7. After installation, according to the instructions on the screen, reboot the system.
Uninstalling the chipset driver for Intel
Uninstalling cannot be done.
Ultra DMA Setting for the HDD
You can set the HDD to the DMA mode by following the steps below.
1. Select [Start Menu] - [Settings] and open the control panel.
2. Select [System] in the control panel.
3. The system Properties dialog box appears. Click the [Device Manager] tab.
4. Select “GENERIC IDE DISK TYPE47” from [Disk drives] and click Properties.
5. The GENERIC IDE DISK TYPE47 Properties dialog box appears. Click the [Settings] tab.
3-48 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
6. Check [DMA] in the [Option] group box.
7. The following dialog box appears. Click OK.
8. Click OK to close the GENERIC IDE DISK TYPE47 Properties dialog box.
9. Click Close to close the System Properties dialog box.
10. The following dialog box appears. Click Yes to restart the system.
Installing the Network Driver
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Win98\Network\PRO98MEM.EXE.
2. The Setup Wizard starts and the License Agreement dialog box is displayed. Select [I accept
the terms in the license agreement] and click Next.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-49
3. The Location to Save Files dialog box is displayed. Input the folder and click Next. The
default setting is C:\IntelPRO.
4. When copy of the file is completed, the following dialog box is displayed. Click Install now.
5. When installing is completed, according to the instructions on the screen, click Restart now.
and reboot the system.
Uninstalling the network driver
1. Select [Start Menu] - [Settings] and open the control panel.
2. Select [Add/Remove Programs] in the control panel.
3. Select [Intel(R) PRO Ethernet Adapter and Software].
4. Click Add/Remove.
5. The confirmation dialog box of the uninstalling is displayed. Click OK.
6. The dialog box to reboot the system is displayed. Click Yes to reboot the system.
Installing the Video Driver
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive and start
\Win98\Video\Win9Xe67.EXE.
2. The Readme.txt dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome screen is displayed. Click Next.
4. The License Agreement dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
5. Installing is completed and the Reboot dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to
restart my computer now] is selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
Uninstalling the video driver
Uninstalling cannot be done.
3-50 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Installing the Sound Driver
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Win98\Sound\SETUP.EXE.
2. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The reboot dialog box is displayed. Confirm that the [Yes, I want to restart my computer
now] is selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
4. The Sound Driver is installed after the system is rebooted.
Uninstalling the sound driver
1. Select [Start Menu] - [Settings] and open the control panel.
2. Select [Add/Remove Programs] in the control panel.
3. Select [SoundMAX].
4. Click Add/Remove.
5. The Setup Type dialog box is displayed. Select [Remove all] and click Next.
6. The reboot dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my computer now] is
selected, and click Finish.
Installing the Touch Panel Driver
This is installed by the exclusive installation program.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Win98\Touch\EPSTP9x.EXE.
2. The Setup Wizard starts and the Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The Choose Destination Location dialog box is displayed. Input the folder and click Next.
The default setting is C:\Program Files\EPSON\TouchPanel.
4. The Setup Complete dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my
computer now] is selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
Uninstalling the touch panel driver
1. Select [Start Menu] - [Settings] and open the control panel.
2. Select [Add/Remove Programs] in the control panel.
3. Select [EPSON Touch Panel Driver].
4. Click Add/Remove.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-51
5. The Confirm File Deletion dialog box is displayed. Click Yes.
6. The reboot dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
7. Uninstalling is completed and the dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
Installing the AC line tool
This tool is the utility to monitor the switching of the power of the system over to the battery
from the AC Line with Windows 2000 when the battery unit (OI-R03) option is attached. For
details, see page 4-67.
Install the AC line tool by the following procedure.
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Win98\Epsbatt\EPSBATT.EXE.
2. The Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The Complete dialog box is displayed. Confirm that [Yes, I want to restart my computer
now] is selected, and click Finish to reboot the system.
Uninstalling the AC line tool
Uninstall the AC line tool by the following procedure.
1. Select [Start Menu] - [Settings] and open the control panel.
2. Select [Add/Remove Programs] in the control panel.
3. Select [EPSON AC Line watching].
4. Click Add/Remove.
5. The Confirm File Deletion dialog box is displayed. Click OK.
6. Reboot the system.
Power button prohibited setting tool
The Power button prohibited setting tool is the tool setting the registry to prohibit the shift to the
shutdown and the stand-by mode even if the front power switch is pressed. It can prevent the
shutdown of the system even if the front power switch is pressed by mistake.
Note on using
When Power Options of Windows are updated, the setting is cleared, so always set after
updating the Power Options.
How to use
use
1. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive. Start
Win2K\Dissw\DISSW.EXE.
3-52 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
2. The following message is displayed. Click Yes. If No is clicked, installation stops and you are
returned to Windows.
3. When setting the registry, the following message is displayed. Click Yes, so Windows is
restarted and the setting becomes valid.
If you click No, the setting returns to Windows without becoming valid. In this case, when
you restart Windows, the setting becomes valid
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-53
Installation for MS-DOS Locally Procured Version
Installation Procedure
If you install MS-DOS Locally procured version, follow the steps below.
Operating System Installation
Insert the MS-DOS startup disk and turn on the IR-320 to perform the Setup.
As for the installation procedure, refer to the MS-DOS manual.
CD-ROM Driver Installation
As for installing MS-DOS only, the CD-ROM drive for the IR-320 is not
recognized. Therefore, by using other PC to read the CD-ROM, install the
CD-ROM driver in the IR-320 after copying the CD-ROM driver on the floppy
disk from the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Network Driver Installation
The Network Driver is provided in the form compressed in the Driver
CD-ROM for the IR-320, but MS-DOS cannot extract the compressed file.
Therefore, by using other PC to read the CD-ROM, install the Network driver
toin the IR-320 after extracting the Network driver in the Driver CD-ROM for
the IR-320.
Touch Panel Driver Installation
Install the Touch Panel Driver from the CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Installing the CD-ROM Driver
After installing the MS-DOS locally procured edition only, the CD-ROM drive of the IR-320 is
not recognized. Therefore, use other PC to read the CD-ROM, and install the CD-ROM driver to
the IR-320 after copying the CD-ROM driver to a floppy disk from the Driver CD-ROM for the
IR-320.
Note
When using the CD-ROM driver, MSCDEX.EXE of MS-DOS is needed.
Install the CD-ROM driver by the following procedure.
1. Start the other PC to read the CD-ROM, and insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 to the
CD-ROM drive. Insert a formatted floppy disk in the FDD.
3-54 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
2. Copy \Dos62\CDROM\CDATAPI.SYS in the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 to the floppy
disk.
3. Turn on the IR-320 to start MS-DOS.
4. Insert the floppy disk copied by step 2 in the FDD of the IR-320.
5. Copy the CDATAPI.SYS on the floppy disk to the optional directory in the hard disk. For
example, copy it on C:\DOS\directory.
6. Add the following description to the CONFIG.SYS of MS-DOS with a text editor, and save it.
The following example is for copying to the C:\DOS\directory. In case of copying to other
directory, describe the directory name with its full path.
DEVICE=C:\DOS\CDATAPI.SYS /D:CDROM
7. Add the following description to the AUTOEXEC.BAT of the MS-DOS with a text editor,
and save it. The following example has MSCDEX.EXE in the C:\DOS\directory. If you have
it in another directory, describe the directory with its full path. In case of the /L option,
specify a drive name. The following is an example specifying the D drive. In case of
specifying the other drive name, describe the optional drive name.
C:\DOS\MSCDEX.EXE /D:CDROM /L:D
8. Restart MS-DOS.
Installing the Network Driver
The Network Driver is provided in the form compressed in the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
MS-DOS cannot extract the compressed file. Therefore, by using another PC to read the
CD-ROM, install the Network driver to the IR-320 after extracting the Network driver in the
Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320.
Note
Windows 98, NT or 2000 is necessary for extracting the compressed file.
Extracting the network driver
Extract the compressed file of the Network Driver by the following procedure.
1. Start the other PC to read the CD-ROM, and start either Windows 98, NT, or 2000.
2. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive.
3. Start \Dos62\Network\PRODOS.EXE.
4. The Setup Wizard starts, and the License Agreement dialog box is displayed. Select [I accept
the terms in the license agreement] and click Next.
5. The dialog box that specifies the place of the copy of the file is displayed. Input the place and
click Next. The default setting is C:\Program Files\PRODOS.
6. When copying of the file is completed, the Release note is displayed.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-55
Installing the network driver
Note
Different environments require different ways of setting the Network Driver. For the details of the
installation procedure, see the RELNOTES.rtf in the C:\Program Files\PRODOS\ directory in the file
extracted by the preceding procedure.
The following example describes the procedure to install the Netware DOS ODI Client Driver.
1. Copy all files in the C:\Program Files\PRODOS\ODI\ directory in the file extracted by the
preceding procedure on the floppy disk.
2. Turn on the IR-320 to start MS-DOS.
3. Insert the floppy disk copied by step 1 in the FDD of the IR-320.
4. Copy all files in the floppy disk to the optional directory in the hard disk. For example, copy
it to the C:\NWCLIENT\ directory.
5. Add the following description to the CONFIG.SYS of the MS-DOS with a text editor, and
save it.
LASTDRIVE=Z
6. Edit the following description in C:\NWCLIENT\NET.CFG with a text editor, and save it.
The following is the example of the setting for the NET.CFG.
LINK DRIVER E100BODI
FRAME ETHERNET_802.2
SPEED=100
PROTOCOL IPX EO Ethernet_802.2
NETWARE DOS REQUESTER
FIRST NETWORK DRIVE = F
PB BUFFERS = 10
3-56 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
7. Add the following description to the AUTOEXEC.BAT of MS-DOS with a text editor, and
save it. The following is the example of the having the driver file in the C:\NWCLIENT\
directory. In case of having it in the other directory, describe as "CD [the directory name]".
CD NWCLIENT
LSL
E100BODI
IPXODI
NETX
8. Turn off the IR-320 and connect it to the network.
9. Turn on the IR-320 and restart MS-DOS.
Installing the Touch Panel Driver
1. Turn on the IR-320 and start MS-DOS.
2. Insert the Driver CD-ROM for the IR-320 in the CD-ROM drive.
3. Copy \Dos62\Touch\CALDSTD.EXE and MEDSTD.COM in the Driver CD-ROM for the
IR-320 to the optional directory in the hard disk. For example, copy it on
C:\Touch\directory.
Executing Touch Panel Driver
Enter the following from the prompt to install the driver:
medstd [Ixx] [Pxxxx] [Bxx] [Fxxxx] [Dx] [S]
The meaning of these parameters are as follows.
Ixx:
Pxxxx:
Bxx:
Fxxxx:
Dx:
S:
IRQ number [Default: 10]
Port address [Default: 2E8]
Baudrate [Default: 9600]
Frequency of Beep [Default: 3E8]
Time of Beep [(25ms)x(X)]
Graphic mode [You need parameter S.]
Text mode [You don’t need parameter S.]
< Example >
medstd I10 P2E8 B96 F3E8 D2 S
Setting of Touch Panel Driver
Touch Panel Driver for Windows
Calibrating the Touch Panel
The touch panel calibration refers to the setting work for matching the physical position where
the operator presses the touch panel with the software position recognized by the computer.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-57
The touch panel calibration is executed when the touch point of the touch panel is displayed.
The touch panel calibration on Windows is executed by using the following procedure:
1. Start Windows.
2. Select Programs – EPSON Touch Panel Tool – Touch Panel Configuration Tool in that order
from the Start menu.
3. The EPSON Touch Panel Configuration Tool starts. Click the Calibration tab.
4. Click Calibration Start. The calibration screen is displayed and a + mark is displayed in the
top left corner of the screen.
5. Press the + mark’s intersection point on the screen. The + mark will then move to the top
center of the screen.
6. Hereafter, press the + mark’s intersection point on the screen. The + mark is thus displayed
consecutively in 9 places, top left, top center, top right, left center, center, right center,
bottom left, bottom center, bottom right. Click Cancel to cancel the calibration operation.
7. The calibration is completed when all the intersection points at all 9 places have been
pressed. Click OK to close the EPSON Touch Panel Configuration Tool.
3-58 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Touch Panel Configuration Tool
The touch panel configuration tool can set the detailed items related to touch panel operation. It
consists of the following four functions.
❏ Calibration Function
❏ Operation Setting Function
❏ Version Display Function
❏ Double Click Permissible Range Setting Function
Note:
Only a user with administrator authority can use the calibration function and operation setting function.
Each item is displayed in gray and cannot be set if an ordinary user uses the tool.
Starting the Touch Panel Configuration Tool
Start the touch panel environment setting tool by the following procedure.
1. Start Windows
2.
Select Programs – EPSON Touch Panel Tool – Touch Panel Configuration Tool in that order
from the Start menu.
3. The Epson Touch Panel Configuration Tool starts.
Calibration Function
The following screen is displayed if the Calibration tab is clicked.
Note:
Only a user with administrator authority can use the calibration function. Each item is displayed in gray
and cannot be set if an ordinary user uses the tool.
Calibration starts when Calibration Start is clicked. See the previous item, “Touch Panel
Calibration,” for details of the calibration procedure.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-59
Operation Setting Function
The following screen is displayed when the Environment Settings tab is clicked.
Note:
Only a user with administrator authority can use the operation setting function. Each item is displayed in
gray and cannot be set if an ordinary user uses the tool.
[Default]
Add a check mark to use the default value for the setting. Each setting item in the
Custom area is displayed in gray and cannot be changed if Default is checked.
Remove the check mark from Default to change the settings for each item.
3-60 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
1. The following dialog box is displayed if the check mark is removed from the Default item.
2. Each of the items below can be set if OK is clicked.
[Stabilization]
Set the jitter correction value within a range of 1 to 20.
The default setting is 1.
The jitter correction takes multiple samplings of the touch panel device’s
coordinate data and calculates the average value to average and thus
stabilize the touch position. The Stabilization setting sets the number of times
coordinate data are sampled.
[Coordinates Data This sets the coordinate data sampling interval within a range of 10 to 155 ms.
Sampling Cycle] The default setting is 10. The coordinate data sampling interval sets the time
coordinate data are sent to the system from the touch panel device.
[On]
This sets the tap sound On or Off. The tap sound is output if this item is
checked. The default setting is On.
[Frequency]
This sets the tap sound frequency within a range of 37 to 16383 Hz. Dragging
the slider left or right changes the setting value. The default setting is 600 Hz.
[Port]
This displays the port used. This item cannot be set here.
[IRQ]
This displays the IRQ used. This item cannot be set here.
[I/O Address]
This displays the I/O address used. This item cannot be set here.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-61
Version Display Function
The following screen is displayed if the Version tab is clicked.
The version information for the Driver, Configuration Tool and Right Button Emulator are
displayed.
Double Click Permissible Range Setting Function
The double click permissible range setting function sets the permissible range for Windows to
recognize a double click.
The permissible range in the Windows default setting value is narrow and if the second tap
position is too far from the first tap position when a double click is attempted on the touch
panel, a double click will not be recognized.
This function can make it easier for the computer to recognize a double click by setting the
permissible double click recognition range so that it is wider.
Note:
When Windows 2000 is set up and a new user is entered, set the double click latitude for each user. As for
the details, refer to the “Setting the recognition range of the double click” section.
Start the Double Click Latitude Setting by the following procedure.
Method
Execute Programs - EPSON Touch Panel Tool - Touch Panel Configuration Tool from the start
menu. Click OK. (There is no need to set other operations.)
Touch Panel Right Button Emulator
The touch panel right button emulator is a tool that switches the tap operation between the right
button and left button in order to perform a mouse right button operation on the touch panel.
The touch panel right button emulator is displayed in the front plane window at all times and
switching between the right button and left button operation can be done any time.
3-62 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
Starting the Touch Panel Right Button Emulator
Start the touch panel right button emulator by the following procedure.
1. Start Windows.
2. Select Programs – EPSON Touch Panel Tool – Right Button Emulator in that order from the
Start menu.
3. The touch panel right emulator starts and the following dialog box is displayed.
Operation
1. Setting the Mode
The touch panel right button emulator is equipped with the following two modes.
1. 1 tap mode
One tap only after the right button is specified is recognized as a right click. This mode is set
as the default.
2. Right Fix Mode
Taps after the right button is specified are always recognized as right clicks.
The mode is switched in the right button emulator menu. The menu is displayed by tapping the
icon on the title bar; then the desired mode is selected. The set mode is displayed underneath the
mouse icon.
2. Switching between the right and left buttons
Switching between the right and left buttons can be accomplished by tapping the mouse icon.
The mouse icon color changes to the color corresponding to the right button or left button each
time the icon is tapped, enabling the operator to recognize which button is selected.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-63
When operating the right button
This operation sends touch panel coordinate data as mouse right button data.
When in the 1 Tap Mode
When in the Right Fix Mode
When operating the left button (normal operation)
This operation sends touch panel coordinate data as mouse left button data.
When in the 1 Tap Mode
When in the Right Fix Mode
Touch Panel Driver for MS-DOS
When the LCD panel is changed or the MEDSTD.COM is installed, calibrate the Touch Panel by
using the calibration.
Note:
MEDSTD.COM must load before the calibration.
Follow the procedures below to calibrate.
1. Type the following:
caldstd I10 P2E8 B96 S
The meaning of these parameters are as follows.
Ixx:
Pxxxx:
Bxx:
S:
IRQ number [Default: 10]
Port address [Default: 2E8]
Baudrate [Default: 9600]
Graphic mode [You need parameter S.]
Text mode [You don’t need parameter S.]
2. The calibration screen is displayed, and nine + mark is displayed.
3. Press the + mark in the top left corner of the screen.
4. Touch the nine "+" marks on the screen.
5. When you finish calibration, press SPACE bar to save the calibrated data. Then press any
key to go to drawing test.
6. If you need to stop the calibration, press the "ESC" key to ignore the calibrated data. Then
press any key to go to drawing test.
3-64 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
HDD Power Down Timer Setting
When the time the HDD is not accessed exceeds the specified time, the HDD motor can be
stopped. The method of setting depends on the OS.
❏ Windows XP Professional
This is set with the OS
❏ Windows 2000 Professional
This is set with the OS
❏ Windows 98 SE
This is set with the OS
❏ Windows NT Workstation 4.0 SP6a
This is set with the BIOS
❏ MS-DOS Ver.6.22
This is set with the BIOS
Windows XP
1. Select [Settings]-[Control Panel]-[Performance and Maintenance]-[Power Options] in the
Start menu of Windows.
2. [Power Options Properties] is displayed. Click the [Power Schemes] tab.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-65
3. Select the time in the [Settings for Home/Office Desk power scheme: Turn off hard disks]
option.
4. Click [OK].
When there is no HDD access for the time set, the HDD Power Down Timer switches over to
HDD Power Down and the motor of the HDD stops.
Windows 2000 Professional
1. Select [Settings]-[Control Panel]-[Power Options] in the Start menu of Windows.
2. [Power Options Properties] is displayed. Click the [Power Schemes] tab.
3-66 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Series Technical Reference Manual
3. Select the time in the [Settings for Home/Office Desk power scheme: Turn off hard disks]
option.
4. Click [OK].
When there is no HDD access for the time set, the HDD Power Down Timer switches over to
HDD Power Down and the motor of the HDD stops.
Windows 98SE
1. Select [Settings]-[Control Panel]-[Power Management] in the Start menu of Windows.
2. [Power Management Properties] is displayed. Click the [Power Schemes] tab.
Rev. C
OS and Drivers 3-67
3. Select the time in the [Settings for Home/Office Desk power scheme: Turn off hard disks]
option.
4. Click [OK].
When there is no HDD access for the time set, the HDD Power Down Timer switches over to
HDD Power Down and the motor of the HDD stops.
Windows NT Workstation 4.0 SP6a
Controlling the HDD motor is done through the BIOS. For the details, see Chapter 5 “BIOS
Functions.”
MS-DOS Ver.6.22
Controlling the HDD motor is done through the BIOS. For the details, see Chapter 5 “BIOS
Functions.”
Shift to the HDD power ON
When access to HDD occurs, the motor of HDD begins to start and the HDD becomes accessible.
3-68 OS and Drivers
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Chapter 4
Utilities
This chapter covers the utilities and development software provided for the IR-320.
Types of Utilities
The utilities and development software for the IR-320 are listed below:
Utilities for MSR (DM-MR123)
These utilities are used to set the functions for the MSR and write them into the keyboard
firmware.
Utility
Utility name
OS
Page
Keyboard firmware setting utility
PKMODE32.EXE
Windows XP/2000/NT/98
4-10
Keyboard firmware setting utility
PKMODE2.EXE
MS-DOS
4-53
Utility for the Key Lock
This utility is used to define the keys for the Key Lock, write them into the keyboard firmware,
and create definition files.
Utility
Utility name
OS
Page
Key Lock setting utility
KEYLOCKCFG.EXE
Windows XP/2000/NT/98
4-12
Utilities for the 28-key Keyboard (DM-KR028)
These utilities are used to define the keys for the 28-key keyboard, write them into the keyboard
firmware, and create definition files.
Utility
Utility name
OS
Page
28 key definition utility
28KEYCFG.EXE
Windows XP/2000/NT/98
4-17
28 key definition utility
POSKB28.EXE
MS-DOS
4-58
Rev. C
Utilities 4-1
Layer-supported 28 Key Definition Utilities
These utilities are used to define 28 keys and support the layer function. With these utilities, it is
possible to freely define and change the definitions of keys on the 28-key keyboard for each
layer.
Utility
Utility name
OS
Page
Layer-supported 28 key definition utility
28KYCFGL.EXE
Windows XP/2000/NT
and Windows 98
4-25
Layer-supported 28 key automatic
definition utility for Windows
PKLDL32.EXE
Windows XP/2000/NT
and Windows 98
4-39
Layer-supported 28 key automatic
definition utility for MS-DOS
PKLDL.EXE
MS-DOS
4-40
Layer switching and reading library
LYFUNC.DLL
PKFUNC.DLL
Windows XP/2000/NT
4-42
Utilities for the 84-key Keyboard (DM-KR084)
These utilities are used to define the keys for the 84-key keyboard, write them into the keyboard
firmware, and create definition files.
Utility
Utility name
OS
Page
84 key definition utility
84KEYCFG.EXE
Windows XP/2000/NT/98
4-43
84 key definition utility
POSKB.EXE
MS-DOS
4-61
Other Keyboard Firmware Related Utilities
These utilities are used to write definition files into the keyboard firmware, and rewrite the
keyboard firmware.
Utility
Utility name
OS
Page
Definition data automatic setting utility
PKLD32.EXE
Windows XP/2000/NT/98
4-48
Definition data automatic setting utility
PKLOAD.EXE
MS-DOS
4-67
Firmware rewriting tool
PKUPDT2.EXE
MS-DOS
4-67
Power Management Related Utilities
These utilities are used to set the save electric power mode and the power management function
to extend the parts lifetime.
Utility
Utility name
OS
Page
Power Management Driver APM2.0
APM32.EXE
Windows NT
4-71
AC Line tool
EPSBATT.EXE
Windows XP/2000
4-76
Power button tool
DISSW.EXE
Windows 2000/98
4-78
4-2 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Logon Keyboard
This utility is used to log on to the OS without connecting the keyboard and the mouse .
Utility
Utility name
OS
Page
Logon Tool
Actinkey/Logonkey
Windows 2000/NT
4-50
Utilities for the Front CompactFlash Adapter
These utilities are included with the front CF adapter (OI-R07) option. While operating the
system, the CompactFlash card can be attached or removed.
Utility
OS
Page
Bay Swap
Windows NT
4-78
A Tool for Software Development
This tool is the development tool to facilitate the development of POS applications by
standardizing the control system of the POS peripheral devices.
Utility
OS
Page
EPSON OPOS ADK
Windows 2000/NT/98/95
4-52
Rev. C
Utilities 4-3
How to Obtain Each Utility
The procedure for obtaining each utility is as follows: For more information about the
installation procedure of each utility, refer to the item describing each utility.
Utility
How to obtain it
Keyboard firmware setting utility (for Windows)
They are preinstalled in the
BACKUP\KEYCFG\WIN\DISK1 folder. They
can be used by running Setup.
Key Lock setting utility (for Windows)
28 key definition Utility (for Windows)
84 key definition Utility (for Windows)
Definition data automatic setting utility (for
Windows)
Keyboard firmware setting utility (for MS-DOS)
28 key definition utility (for MS-DOS)
They are preinstalled in the
BACKUP\KEYCFG\DOS folder. They can be
used by running Setup.
84 key definition utility (for MS-DOS)
Definition data automatic setting utility (for MSDOS)
Layer-supported 28 key definition utility
Layer-supported 28 key automatic definition
utility for Windows 95/98 and Windows 2000/NT
These utilities are not preinstalled. If you want
to use any of these utilities, please contact
an EPSON dealer.
Layer-supported 28 key automatic definition
utility for MS-DOS
Layer switching and reading library
Power Management Driver APM 2.0
This is included with the battery unit
(OI-R03-021).
AC Line tool
They are preinstalled in the BACKUP\Epsbatt
folder.
Power button tool
They are preinstalled in the BACKUP\Dissw
folder.
Logon Tool
They are preinstalled in the BACKUP\LOGON
folder. They can be used by running Setup.
Bay Swap
This is included with the front CF adapter (OIR07) of the option.
EPSON OPOS ADK
They are preinstalled in the
BACKUP\OPOSADK folder. They can be
used by running Setup.
CAUTION
The floppy disks that come with the DM-KR028 and DM-MR123 also contain utilities, but
do not use these utilities with the IR-310 and IR-320.
4-4 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Keyboard Firmware Related Utilities (MSR, Key Lock, 28-key Keyboard)
These include utilities related to the keyboard firmware. These utilities are used to set the MSR,
the definition data for the Key Lock, and the definition data for the 28-key keyboard.
Keyboard Firmware
What is the keyboard firmware?
The IR-320 is equipped with a special POS device keyboard controller LSI, and the following
devices are supported by the firmware of this keyboard controller.
•
•
•
•
•
Key Lock of IR-320
MSR (DM-MR123)
28-key keyboard (DM-KR028)
PS/2 keyboard
Extemally connected POS keyboard
The input data from these devices is converted into the scan code of the keyboard according to
the code conversion table in the keyboard firmware, all of which is then handled as keyboard
input on the system side.
MSR
28 keyboard
PS/2 keyboard
POS keyboard
The code conversion table has the key definition data for converting the setting values and input
data of each device into a scan code, which can be rewritten by the utility of each device.
However, the externally connected POS keyboard must be set by using a special tool, and the
setting values are then written into the memory in the keyboard.
The following operations can be performed by having the IR-320 manage the code conversion
table:
•
Rev. C
Key definition data and other data that may change frequently can be managed
separately from applications. This will reduce the number of application development
steps.
Utilities 4-5
•
Change and management can be performed easily since key definition data is in the
system. By creating a batch file for setup (a floppy disk can be used to store this file
including definition data and a batch file program), systems having the same settings
can be set up in a short period of time.
•
By storing key definition data in a server, the key definition data of multiple systems can
be managed uniformly and the definition data of all systems can be changed
simultaneously.
Keyboard Firmware and Utilities
Utilities for setting the MSR, writing the definition data for the KeyLock and 28-key keyboard
into the keyboard firmware and others are provided.
Also, the settings for the MSR and the definition data for the Key Lock and 28-key keyboard can
be saved in a file as a definition file, and that definition file can be written into the keyboard
firmware by using an appropriate definition data automatic setting utility. This method makes it
possible to set up multiple systems using the same settings, or it can be executed as a batch file,
and for writing it into another system are also provided.
Function
Utility for Windows
Utility for MS-DOS
MSR setting
PKMODE32.EXE
PKMODE2.EXE
Key Lock definition
KEYLOCKCFG.EXE
None
28 key definition
28KEYCFG.EXE
POSKB28.EXE
84 key definition
84KEYCFG.EXE
POSKB.EXE
Layer-supported 28 key definition
28KYCFGL.EXE
None
Writing definition files into
keyboard firmware
PKLOAD32.EXE
PKLOAD.EXE
Writing definition files into
keyboard firmware (for layersupported 28 keys)
PKLDL32.EXE
PKLDL.EXE
Firmware rewriting
None
PKUPDT2.EXE
How to Use Keyboard Firmware Related Utilities
Settings for the programming of an external POS keyboard
To program an external POS keyboard, it is necessary to turm off some of the keyboard
firmware functions in order to prevent system malfunction. Check the [Ignore MSR/Keyboard
Commands] check box in the MSR setting utility (keyboard firmware setting utility), or use the
CMDOFF command in MS-DOS.
Setting up one system
1. Connect the unit you are using, and check its operation.
2. Connect a PS/2 keyboard to the keyboard/mouse connector.
4-6 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
3. If keyboard firmware related utilities are not installed, install them according to the
procedure described later. (These utilities are not installed during the initial setup.)
4. Perform key definitions and setting using the utilities provided for each of the units you are
using, and write them into the keyboard firmware. It the same settings will be used for
multiple systems, create a definition file at this time.
This completes the setup of one system. To verify the contents of the settings start Windows
“Notepad” or another text editor, and operate each unit. If data is input normally, the setup was
successful.
Setting up multiple systems
1. Set up and define the units you are using for one system. Create the definition files (*.k28,
*.kyl and other files) of each of the units at this time.
2. If you are using an MSR, create a definition file (*.pkl file) using a text editor.
3. Copy each of the definition files onto a floppy disk (or other appropriate media).
4. Create an appropriate folder in the hard disk of each system, and copy the definition files
stored on the floppy disk to that folder.
5. Using an appropriate definition data setting utility, write the contents of the definition files
into the keyboard firmware. Because the definition data setting utility only defines one file
at a time, write the settings for the Key Lock and 28-key keyboard sequentially. You can
create a batch file to execute this operation so that the definition data can be rewritten each
time the system is started, or the definition data can also be rewritten using a file on a server
on an intranet.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-7
Although the keyboard firmware itself can be written by using a keyboard firmware rewriting
tool, such tools are not available for Windows.
Settings of MSR
PKMODE32.EXE (Win)
PKMODE2.EXE (DOS)
MSR Definition file [*.pkl]
Create this file
using a text editor
Definition of the Key Lock
KEYLOCKCFG.EXE (Win
Definition file
*.kyl]
Definition of the 28 keyboard
28KEYCFG.EXE (Win)
POSKB28.EXE(DOS)
Definition file
*.k28]
Definition file
*.l28]
Definition file
*.k84]
Definition of the 28 keyboard
(Layer-supported)
28KYCFGL.EXE (Win)
Definition of the 84 keyboard
84KEYCFG.EXE (Win)
POSKB.EXE(DOS)
[*.xxx] File name.Extension
(Win) Windows
(DOS) DOS
Definition file
Keyboard Firmware
PKLOAD32.EXE(Win)
PKLOAD.EXE(DOS)
PKLOAD32.EXE(Win)
PKLOAD.EXE(DOS)
PKLOAD32.EXE(Win)
PKLOAD.EXE(DOS)
PKLDL32.EXE(Win)
PKLDL.EXE(DOS)
PKLDL32.EXE(Win)
PKLDL.EXE(DOS)
*.FLD]
PKUPDT2.EXE(DOS)
Installing
The following four utilities can be used after they are installed:
•
Keyboard Firm Setting utility
•
Key Lock Setting utility
•
28-Key Definition utility
•
Automatic Definition Data Setting utility
For installation, use the following procedure:
1. Execute C:\Backup\keycfg\win\Disk1\Setup.exe.
2. The installation program starts, and the Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
3. The Choose Destination Location dialog box is displayed. Specify the destination of the
installation directory (c:\Program Files\Key Config is the default). Click Next.
4-8 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
4. The Select Program Folder dialog box is displayed. Specify the program folder name
(Keyboard Config Utilities is the default). Click Next.
5. The screen for confirming the setting contents is displayed. Click Next. Installation starts.
6. Upon completion of the installation, the Setup Complete dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-9
Keyboard Firmware Setting Utility (for Windows XP/2000/NT/98)
The keyboard firmware setting utility for Windows XP/2000/NT/98 changes keyboard
firmware. This utility is used to change the MSR settings.
Start
The keyboard firmware setting utility (PKMODE32.EXE) is stored in the following directory by
default.
C:/Program Files\Key Config\
Start the keyboard firmware utility in either of the following ways.
❏ Double-click PKMODE32.EXE from Windows Explorer.
❏ Select Keyboard Config Utilities and then MSR & Keyboard Configuration Utility from the
Program menu.
Note:
This program is also contained on the floppy disk packaged with the MSR unit and the 28-key keyboard
unit. Do not use this floppy disk, however, because it is exclusively for the IR-300.
When the program starts, the following screen appears.
4-10 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
The following paragraphs define each item on the screen:
❏ Ignore MSR/Keyboard Command
If this check box is checked, all commands to the keyboard firm are not accepted. Typically,
this check box is checked for use with the external programmable keyboard. It has not been
checked in the initial setting.
Note:
Be careful that if this check box is checked, this utility cannot be started unless the main body is
turned off or reset. To uncheck this check box, reboot the main body, or, alternatively, start this utility
with the external keyboard disconnected.
❏ Use MSR Beep
This is used to sound the beep at the time of reading.
❏ MSR Track Recognition (ISO/JIS1 Track 1, ISO/JIS1 Track 2, ISO Track 3)
Check the check box of the track to be read. More than one track may be specified
accordingly. Track 1,2 and Track 3 have been selected in the initial setting.
❏ MSR Code Type (English,Japanese,French,German,Spanish)
Selection is made according to the language setting of Windows.
❏ MSR Start/End Sentinels (Card Start, Card End, ISO/JIS1 Track 1 Start, ..., JIS2 Start, JIS2
End)
The characters to be prefixed and affixed to the data during the MSR reading are specified.
It is possible to specify this setting for each card and each track. Leave this field blank if no
character is to be added. The default settings are as follows:
Track 1 Start: “%” Track 1 End: “?”
Track 2 Start: “;” Track 2 End: “?”
Track 3 Start: “+” Track 3 End: “?”
Use any of the following special characters:
Carriage return:
Tab:
“\”:
Others:
Rev. C
“\R” or “\r”
“\T” or “\t”
“\\”
“\xx” Specified directly with xx, representing character codes as
hexadecimals.
Utilities 4-11
OPOS ADK Settings with the DM-MR123
When using the DM-MR123 with the EPSON OPOS ADK, pay attention to the following items.
❏ The DM-MR123 is applicable to EPSON OPOS ADK Ver. 1.9x and newer versions. To read
the JIS2 card by using the DM-MR123, use EPSON OPOS ADK Ver. 1.9x or newer version.
❏ When the DM-MR123 is used as a conventional model (DM-MR111), EPSON OPOS ADK
Ver. 1.62 or newer versions can be used. In this case, select the DM-MR111-012 as an
applicable model, although, it cannot read the JIS2 card. Also, specify a track that can be
read by the Keyboard Firm Setting utility for Windows or the PKMODE2 utility.
❏ Select the 101K/B keyboard.
❏ To have the JIS2 type card read, set the end flag to Space + Line feed.
JIS2 End “\20\r”
Key Lock Setting Utility (for Windows XP/2000/NT/98)
The Key Lock Setting utility sets the function of each position of the key lock.
Start
The Key Lock Setting utility (KYLCKCFG.EXE) has been registered in the following directory in
the initial setting:
C:\Program Files\Key Config\
This utility can be started by either of the following methods:
❏ Double-click Kylckcfg.EXE on Explorer.
❏ Select Keyboard Config Utilities and then Keylock Configuration Utility from the Program
menu.
4-12 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
When the program starts, the Startup screen is displayed.
Speed Buttons
The speed button menu, which is composed of eight buttons, is displayed under the title bar of
the Key Lock Setting utility. Click these speed buttons to call up the desired function quickly.
Exit
Load
New
Exit
New
Load
Save
Code
Label
Prog One
Prog All
Rev. C
Save
Code
Label
Prog
One
Prog All
Exits the Key Lock Setting utility.
Clears the button’s function and creates a new setting.
Loads a saved setting.
Saves the current setting.
Opens the KeyCode dialog box.
Opens the KeyLabel dialog box.
If you click this button while a key is selected, only the code for the selected key is
programmed.
Programs the settings of all the keys.
Utilities 4-13
Key Definitions
Each key on the screen corresponds with each key position of the manager key. For defining
each key, use the following procedure:
1. Click the key you want to set to use this code, and it becomes selected. (Clicking it again
cancels the selection.)
2. Click Code, and open the KeyCode dialog box.
3. Input the code for the selected key from the keyboard. This code can be up to a maximum of
63 bytes.
4. If you click OK, the setting becomes valid, and the key dialog box is closed. If you click
Cancel, the setting is canceled. If you click Reset, the code is cleared.
Setting the Key Label
Use the following steps to set the key label displayed on the key position button.
1. Click the key you want to label, and it becomes selected.
2. If Label is clicked, the KeyLabel dialog box is opened.
3. Input any characters as the label.
4. If you click OK, the input characters are displayed on the button, and the KeyLabel dialog
box closes. If you click Cancel, the input characters are canceled. Up to 20 characters can be
input. “|” is regarded as a new line.
4-14 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Key Program
To assign a setting to an actual key, you need to run the program. Run the program by either of
the following methods:
❏ Click Prog One while a button is selected. Only the selected key is programmed.
❏ Click Prog All. All the keys are programmed.
If the program ends correctly, the following dialog box is displayed.
Saving the Settings
Save the current settings as a file with the following steps.
1. If you click Save, the Save As dialog box is displayed.
2. If you input a file name and click Save, the settings are saved in a file. Use the file extension
.kyl.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-15
Loading the Settings
Load the settings as follows.
1. If you click Load, the Open dialog box is displayed.
2. If you select a file name and click Open, the selected setting is loaded.
New
To clear the current settings and create new settings, click New. All the key settings are cleared.
Exit
If you click Exit, the key lock setting utility is exited.
4-16 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
28-Key Definition Utility (for Windows XP/2000/NT/98)
The 28-Key Definition utility can define the keys of the 28-key keyboard unit connected to the
IR-320 in Windows.
For information on definable keys, see the table “Definable keys” on page 4-23.
Note:
When using this utility, observe the following:
The Shift, Ctrl, or Alt keys cannot be registered alone, but they can be registered in combination with other
keys.
Pressing the Windows, Menu, or Print Screen keys is specially treated on the system, and, therefore,
these keys cannot be registered alone.
Concurrent pressing of Ctrl+Alt+Del, Ctrl+Esc, or Alt+Tab cannot be defined.
Any other key definition utility cannot be programmed together with this utility.
Do not operate the mouse, the touch panel, the keyboard, or any other inputting device while the program
of this utility is being executed.
Startup
The 28-Key Definition utility (28KEYCFG.EXE) has been copied in the directory as specified in
the installation procedure. (If the directory is not specified, this utility is copied in the
c:\Program Files\Key config directory.)
This utility can be started by either of the following methods:
❏ Double-click 28KEYCFG.EXE in Windows Explorer.
❏ Select Keyboard Config Utilities and then 28 Keyboard Configuration Utility from the
Program menu.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-17
When the program starts, the Startup screen is displayed.
Speed Button
The speed button menu, which is composed of 12 buttons, is displayed under the title bar of the
28-Key Definition utility. The function to be executed can be quickly called by pressing this
speed button.
Exit
Load
New
Exit
New
Load
Save
Code
Label
Font
Color
Prog One
Prog All
View
4-18 Utilities
Save
Code
Font
Label
Color
Prog
One
View
Prog
All
Print
Exits the 28-Key Definition utility.
Clears the button’s function and creates a new setting.
Loads a saved setting.
Saves the current setting.
Opens the KeyCode dialog box.
Opens the KeyLabel dialog box.
Opens the Font dialog box.
Opens the Color Specification dialog box
Programs only the code for the selected key when this button is clicked while a
key is selected.
Programs the settings of all the keys.
Opens the Key View window, and displays the key top.
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Print
Displays the Print dialog box.
Key Definitions
Each key on the screen corresponds with the actual key-top of the keyboard unit. For defining
the key top, use the following procedure:
1. Click the key you want to set to use this code, and it becomes selected. (Clicking it again
cancels the selection.)
2. Click Code, and open the KeyCode dialog box.
3. Input the code for the selected key from the keyboard. This code can be up to a maximum of
63 bytes.
When you select a key, if you hold down Shift and click the key immediately to the right of
or immediately below the selected key, the two keys are connected. By repeating this
procedure, a number of keys can be connected to create one large key. If you press Shift
while the connected key is selected, the connection is canceled.
4. If you click OK, the setting becomes valid, and the key dialog box is closed. If you click
Cancel, the setting is canceled. If you click Reset, the code is cleared.
Setting the Key Label
Use the following steps to set the key label displayed on the key position button.
1. Click the key you want to label, and it becomes selected.
2. If Label is clicked, the KeyLabel dialog box is opened.
3. Input any characters as the label.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-19
4. If you click OK, the input characters are displayed on the button, and the KeyLabel dialog
box closes. If you click Cancel, the input characters are canceled. Up to 20 characters can be
input. “|” is regarded as a new line. When the Center check box is checked, the inputted
character is displayed on the key top in the centered position.
Setting the Key Top Color
For setting the key top color, use the following procedure:
1. Click the key to be set on key top color to make it ready for setting.
2. Click Color. The Color dialog box is displayed.
3. Set the key top color by clicking the color to be set from the color palette, and click OK.
4-20 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
4. To set any color other than the basic colors as a key top color, click Define Custom Colors.
Drag the mouse on the color slider, and select the color. Alternatively, enter the numeric
value, and click Add to Custom Colors. Then, the created color is additionally displayed on
the Custom colors color palette. Select the color, and click OK.
5. When OK is clicked, the key is redrawn in the selected color, and the Color dialog box is
closed. When Cancel is clicked, the selected color is cancelled.
Key Program
To assign a setting to an actual key, run the program by either of the following methods:
❏ Click Prog One while a button is selected. Only the selected key is programmed.
❏ Click Prog All. All the keys are programmed.
If the program ends correctly, the following dialog box is displayed.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-21
Saving the Settings
You can save the current settings as a file with the following steps.
1. If you click Save, the Save As dialog box is displayed.
2. If you input a file name and click Save, the settings are saved in a file. Use the file
extension .k28.
Loading the Settings
Load the settings as follows.
1. If you click Load, the Open dialog box is displayed.
2. If you select a file name and click Open, the selected setting is loaded.
New
To clear the current settings and create new settings, click New. All the key settings are cleared.
4-22 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Displaying the Key Top
When View is clicked, the Key View window opens, so that the key top label and colors can be
confirmed. To close this window, click the X on the right end of the title bar.
Exit
When Exit is clicked, the 28-Key Definition utility is exited.
List of Definable Keys
Following is a list of definable keys for the supplied utilities. “Yes” means “can be defined”;
“No” means “cannot be defined” in the table below.
Definable keys
Utility
28KEYCFG.EXE
OS
Windows XP/2000/NT/98
Language
Any language
Keyboard
101, 102, 106 series
Keys that cannot be defined,
depending on OS
Print Screen, Scroll Lock, Pause, Num Lock, Caps Lock, Windows, Shift,
Alt, Ctrl, Menu, Ctrl+Alt+Del, Alt+Esc, Alt+Tab, Ctrl+Esc
Limits on key combinations
Single
Shift
Ctrl
Alt
Esc
Yes
Yes
No
No
Fn (Function Key)
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
13457890
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
26
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
a-z
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Tab
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
BS
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Space
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Enter
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
-[]¥
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Rev. C
Utilities 4-23
Definable keys (continued)
=;’‘,./
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Ins
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Del
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Home
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
End
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
PageUp
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
PageDown
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
↑
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
↓
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
→
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
←
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
/ * (Ten key)
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
- + (Ten key)
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Enter (Ten key)
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
0 . 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 (Ten key)
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
4-24 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Layer 28-key Keyboard Definition Utility (for Windows XP/2000/NT and Windows 98)
This utility is a utility for connecting the 28-key keyboard unit (DM-KR028) to the IR-310/320
and using the layer function.The layer function divides the key definitions for the 28 keys of the
28-key keyboard unit into units called layers, makes it possible to define multiple layers and
thus enables the user to make (28 keys x number of layers) key definitions. Multiple layers can
be switched instantaneously through the layer change key or through software, enabling input
from more than 28 keys.
There are two versions of the Layer 28-key Keyboard Definition Utility, for Windows95/98 and
Windows NT/2000.
The layer 28-key keyboard definition utility has not been installed in the products. If you want
this software, contact your EPSON distributor.
Outline
What is the Layer Function?
A maximum of 28 keys could be programmed in the 28-key keyboard, but the key definitions varied
depending on the application that was being run. If defining of more than 28 keys was desired, it was
necessary to judge the input status in the application and switch the key inputs.
Then, by enabling definition of the 28 keys in so-called layer units, and making it possible to define
multiple layers, (28 keys x number of layers) could be defined enabling key input from more than 28 keys.
This is the layer function.
There are two methods of switching layers instantaneously.
Changing layers using the Change Layer Key (Shift key type)
A key is defined in advance for switching to each layer, with the specified layer activated while that key is
pressed, then key data for the specified layer being input by pressing keys while in that state.
Using this method, it is not necessary for the application to be aware of the layer status.
The shift key type defines a specific key, such as the computer’s Shift key or Ctrl key, as the change layer
key. Layers are then changed only while that key is being pressed, with the layer returning to "Layer 0"
when it is released.
Changing Layers using Software
Software functions include the layer status read function and the layer setting function. When the
application switches to the specified layer, the key data for the specified layer are input when the keys are
pressed. In this case, management of the layers is all performed by the application, and the current layer is
maintained until the application changes layers.
Note:
❑
Rev. C
Do not use the above 2 methods simultaneously. Using them at the same time may cause differences
between the key definition recognized by the application and the actual input.
Utilities 4-25
Layer Function Specifications
Number of Layers
: 4 Layers (Layers No. 0 - 3)
Number of Defined Data
: Maximum 63 data items (per key, per layer)
Default Layer
: Layer 0 (when starting)
Layer Switching Method
: Shift key type
Change Layer Key
: It is possible to set a single change layer key for each layer (a total of 3 keys).
If multiple change layer keys are pressed at the same time, the change layer key
that was pressed last becomes the enabled key.
Notes:
❑
The layer returns to Layer 0 when the change layer key is released after being pressed. In the case of
changing a layer other than 0 using the software, as the same method, it returns to Layer 0 without
returning the layer set with the software.
❑
In case multiple change layer keys are pressed, when any change layer keys are released, the layer
returned 0 not to change the layer is pressing. Under this case, when the layer is changed using the
software, it returned Layer 0 at the same time of other change layer keys are released.
❑
In the previous 28-key definition utility and 84-key definition key, keys are defined with respect to
Layer 0 (when starting), so if a layer other than Layer 0 is set, keys are not input.
❑
The KeyLock key can be operated without relation to the layer function.
❑
If the layer function is not being used, use the layer 28-key definition utility and leave the change layer
keys unset.
Software Configuration
Layer 28-key Definition Utility
:28KYCFGL.EXE
Layer 28-key Auto Definition Utility for Windows
: PKLDL32.EXE
Layer 28-key Auto Definition Utility for MS-DOS : PKLDL.EXE
Layer Switching and Reading Library (Windows edition)
Note:
There is no layer version of the 28-key definition utility for DOS.
4-26 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Installation Procedure
Note:
This explanation is for Windows 2000. ?For Windows NT is a same operation step. ??For Windows 95/98
differs some part of the steps, so they are explained later.
Install this utility by the following procedure.
1. Double click on SETUP.EXE to start installation.
2. The Welcome dialog box is displayed. Confirm the contents, then click the Next button.
3. The Choose Destination Location dialog box is displayed. Confirm the installation
destination folder, the click the Next button. C:\Program Files\28 KB Config(4L)\ is set as
the default. This can be changed if necessary.
4. The Select Program Folder dialog box is displayed. Confirm the program folder name, then
click the Next button. 28 KB Config Utilities(4L) is set as the default. This can be changed if
necessary.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-27
5. The Start Copying Files dialog box is displayed. Confirm the contents, then click the Next
button.
6. Installation begins.
Windows XP/2000/NT
7. The Setup Complete dialog box is displayed. Select "Yes, I want to restart my computer
now." , and click the [Finish] button to restart the windows.
Windows 98
7. The Setup Complete dialog box is displayed. Click the Finish button to end the installation.
Uninstall Procedure
Uninstall this utility by the following procedure.
1. Open the Control Panel.
2. Double click on Add/Remove Programs.
3. Click the Install/Remove tab then select 28K/B Config Utilities (4 Layers Supported) for
Windows NT from the list box.
4-28 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Windows XP/2000/NT
Windows 98
4. Click the Add/Remove button.
5. The Confirm File Deletion dialog box is displayed. Click the Yes button.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-29
6. If the following dialog box is displayed and you are asked to confirm whether to delete
shared files, click the Yes to All button.
7. If the following dialog box is displayed asking you to reconfirm whether to delete the shared
files, click the Yes button.
8. The following dialog box is displayed, and the uninstall process is completed. Click the OK
button.
Setting the Utility
Layer 28-key Definition Utility
The Layer 28-key Definition Utility can define the keys of the 28-key keyboard unit in Windows. Setting of
codes for the 28-key keyboard can be done for layers 0~3, a total of 4 layers.
Notes:
❑
Be careful of the following points when using this utility.
4-30 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
❑
The Shift, Ctrl and Alt keys cannot be registered independently. Register them in combination with
other keys.
❑
The NumLock, ScrollLock, Pause and CapsLock keys cannot be registered.
❑
Pressing of the Windows key, Menu key and Print Screen keys is handled specially by the system,
so these keys cannot be registered independently.
❑
The Ctrl+Alt+Del, Ctrl+Esc, Alt+Esc and Alt+Tab keys pressed simultaneously cannot be defined.
❑
This utility cannot be run simultaneously with other key definition utilities such as "28keycfg.exe".
❑
Do not operate the mouse, touch panel, keyboard or other input device while this utility program is
running (while definition data are being written).
❑
The file extension is ".L28". The format of this utility is not compatible with the file format of the
previous 28-key definition utility.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-31
Starting
The 28-key definition utility (28KYCFGL.EXE) is copied to the directory specified during installation.
The utility is copied to C:\Program Files\28 KB Config(4L) if a directory is not specified.
This utility is started by either of the following two methods.
❏ Select 28KYCFGL.EXE in Windows Explorer and run it.
❏ Select [28 KB Config Utilities(4L)] - [28 KB Config Utility (4 Layers Supported)] in the
Programs menu.
The following starting screen is displayed when the program starts.
Speed Buttons
The speed buttons, configured from 13 buttons, are displayed under the title bar. Clicking these speed
buttons enables the desired function to be called up immediately.
Exit
Load
New
Code
Save
Label
Font
Color
Prog
One
View
Prog
All
Print
Option
Exit
Closes the utility.
New
Clears the button’s setting and creates a new setting.
Load
Reads the stored settings.
Save
Saves the current settings.
4-32 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Label
Opens the Label dialog box.
Code
Opens the Code dialog box.
Font
Opens the Font dialog box.
Color
Opens the color specification dialog box.
Prog One
When a button is selected, clicking this button causes only the key
corresponding to the selected button to be programmed.
Prog All
The settings of all the buttons are programmed.
View
Opens the View window and displays the key tops.
Print
Displays the Print dialog box.
Option
Displays the Option dialog box.
Key Definitions
Each key on the screen corresponds to an actual key top on the keyboard unit. Key tops are defined by the
following procedure.
1. Select the key which you would like to set the code for. Clicking it once more cancels the
selection.
2. The Code dialog box opens when the Code button is clicked.
3. Select the list box with the layer name where the key code is to be set by clicking it with the
mouse.
4. Input the code to be set for the selected key from the keyboard. A code with a length of up to
63 bytes can be input.
5. Repeat the same procedure, inputting the codes to be set for the keys in each layer.
6. Clicking the OK button enables the settings and closes the Code dialog box. Clicking the
Cancel button cancels the settings. Clicking the Clear button clears the code input up to
that point.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-33
Linking with Keys
When a key is selected, if the key to the right or directly below that key is selected while the Shift key is
pressed, those two keys are linked. By repeating this operation, multiple keys can be linked, enabling the
creation of a large key. When a linked key is selected, if the selected key is selected again while the Shift
key is pressed, the link is cancelled.
Defining Change Layer Keys
Define change layer keys by the following procedure.
1. Click the Option button to open the Option dialog box.
2. The change layer keys for each respective layer, 1 to 3, can be set in the 3 drop down lists in
the dialog box. Select the number of the key that is to be used as the change layer key from
the drop down list. The change layer key is not set if "-" is selected.
Note:
❑
The key set as the change layer key cannot be used for code input or by itself in programming.
Setting Key Labels
Set the key labels displayed on the keytops by the following procedure.
1. Select the key that the key label is to be set for.
2. The Label dialog box opens when the Label button is clicked.
4-34 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
3. Input the desired characters.
4. Clicking the OK button displays the input characters on the keytop and closes the dialog
box. Clicking the Cancel button discards the input characters. Up to 20 characters can be
input. A "|" is regarded as the starting point of a new line.
If the [Center] check box is checked, the displayed input characters are arranged around the
center of the keytop.
Setting the Keytop Color
Set the keytop color by the following procedure.
1. Select the key that the color is to be set for and activate it.
2. Clicking the Color button displays the color dialog box.
3. Set the keytop color. Select the color to be se from the color palette.
4. Clicking the OK button causes the key to be redrawn in the selected color and closes the
Color dialog box. Clicking the Cancel button discards the selected color.
Setting the Font
Set the font by the following procedure.
1. Select the key that the font is to be set for and activate it.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-35
2. Clicking the Font button displays the Font dialog box.
3. Set the font.
4. Clicking the OK button sets the selected font. Clicking the Cancel button discards the
selected font.
Programming Keys
To assign settings to the actual keys, it is necessary to program them. Program the keys by either of the
following methods.
❏ While a key is in the selected state, click the Prog One button. Only the selected key is
programmed.
❏ Click the Prog All button. All the keys are programmed.
The following dialog box is displayed if the programming ends normally.
4-36 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Saving the Settings
The current settings can be saved as a file. Save the settings by the following procedure.
1. Clicking the Save button displays the "Save as..." dialog box.
2. Input the file name and click the Save button to save the settings in a file. Be sure to specify
".L28" as the file extension.
3. The following dialog box is displayed if a file with the same name as the specified file
already exists. Clicking the Yes button overwrites the existing file. Clicking the No button
cancels the save operation.
Notes
❑
If the Exit, New or Load button is clicked while the settings are changed but have not been saved, the
dialog boxes shown below are displayed, and confirmation of whether or not to save the current
settings is requested. Clicking the "Yes" button opens the Save dialog box. Clicking the "No" button
discards the current settings and causes processing to resume. Clicking the "Cancel" button returns the
program to the previous state.
If the Exit button is clicked
Rev. C
Utilities 4-37
If the New button is clicked
If the Load button is clicked
Reading the Settings
Read the saved settings by the following procedure.
1. Clicking the Load button displays the Open File dialog box.
2. Select the file name, then click the Open button to read the selected settings.
Creating New Settings
Click the New button to clear the settings used up to the present and set new settings. All the key settings
are cleared.
4-38 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Displaying the Keytops
Clicking the View button opens the View window and enables the keytop labels, colors and fonts, etc. to
be confirmed. Close the window by clicking the x button on the right end of the title bar.
Printing the Keytops
Clicking the Print button opens the Print dialog box. Click the OK button to start printing.
Close
Clicking the Exit button closes the Layer 28 Definition Utility.
Layer 28-key Auto Definition Utility for Windows
Function
This utility loads definition files created by the Layer 28 Keyboard Definition Utility. It is used for batch
processing, etc.
Starting
The Layer 28-key Auto Definition Utility for Windows (PKLDL32.EXE) is copied to the directory specified
during installation.
The utility is copied to C:\Program Files\28 KB Config(4L) if a directory is not specified. This utility is
started by the following method.
❏ Input the following at the command prompt.
[Path] PKLDL32 Filename [/n]
Rev. C
Utilities 4-39
File Name:
This is the path name of the set file ("* * * .l28").
/n:
If the n option is specified, the following dialog box is displayed during
closing.
A dialog box that shows the status during transfer of the settings is displayed. The following contents are
displayed in the dialog box. nn is the layer No. or the key No., and rr is the number of retries, up to a
maximum of 6 times.
Switching layers Now switching to layer #nn(xrr)...
Setting 28 keys
Now Programming keyboard #nn(xrr)...
Setting Change Layer key
Now Programming layer change key #nn(xrr)...
Notes
❑
This utility is available in an English message version only.
❑
This utility cannot be used during programming with 28keyCfg. or other key definition utility.
❑
The keyboard and mouse do not respond during reading or writing of the settings.
❑
As much as possible, do not perform any operations that would generate an interrupt, such as tapping
the touch panel, during reading or writing of the settings.
The Layer 28-key Auto Definition Utility for MS-DOS
Outline
This is a MS-DOS utility that loads definition files created with the layer 28 keyboard definition utility. It is
used when performing batch processing, etc.
Command
Execute commands in the following format.
PKLDL.EXE data-file
Processing Details
This utility sets the following data automatically.
•
Saved Layer 28-key Auto Definition Utility for Windows files (.L28).
This utility is not compatible with the following data.
•
Saved Windows 84-key Definition files (.K84)
•
Saved Windows 28-key Definition files (.K28)
4-40 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
•
Saved Windows KeyLock Definition files (.KYL)
•
Scan code table rewrite files for MSR (.PKL)
Checking of the validity of a specified file is done by the file extension, so be sure to specify the file
extension precisely.
Notes
❑
This utility starts and runs in MS-DOS. (It cannot be run from the DOS box.)
❑
This utility uses the keyboard interface for communications with the firmware. For that reason, do not
use an external keyboard, the 28-key keyboard, KeyLock or MSR during execution. Errors will occur if
these are operated during data communications, and it may stop running normally.
❑
Do not press Reset or turn the power off while this utility is running.
Messages
Message
Content
EPSON Layer Keyboard Auto Definition Utility Vx.xx.xx
When started
Usage:
PKLDL data-file
data-file: definition data file
.L28 :Layer 28Key definition data
Usage
EPSON Layer Keyboard Auto Definition Utility Vx.xx.xx
Now transfer 28Key Definition data .........
28-key definition data
transfer
Error Message
Content
Firmware version is not correct
The firmware version is incorrect.
Invalid parameter
An invalid parameter was
specified.
Firmware communication error
Firmware communications failed.
File access error : No such file or directory
File access failed.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-41
End Codes
End Code
Content
0
Normal end.
10
The firmware version is incorrect. Or, it was executed at another PC
(abnormal end).
11
Parameter error (abnormal end).
14
An error occurred in communications with the firmware (abnormal
end).
20
An error occurred during file access (abnormal end).
21
There was an error in the file’s data format (abnormal end).
Layer Change / Reading Library
Function
This library offers functions that is necessary when using the layer function.
Functions
int Select28KeyLayer(int layer)
[Function]
Switches the layer that is currently in use.
[Argument]
Specifies the number of the layer from 0 to 3 to use, or default layer (0x0f).
[Return Values]
0
-20
-21
-22
: Normal End
: Communications error
: Opening error
: Argument error
int GetCurrent28KeyLayer(void)
[Function]
Acquires the layer that is currently in use.
[Argument]
None
[Return Value]
0 to 3 : The currently selected layer No.
-20
: Communications error
-21
: Opening error
Notes
❑
Copy LYFUNC.DLL and PKFUNC.DLL to the same folder as the application program.
❑
This library cannot be used during programming with 28keyCfg., etc.
❑
The keyboard and mouse do not respond during reading or writing of the settings.
❑
Do not perform any operations that would generate an interrupt, such as tapping the touch panel,
during reading or writing of the settings.
4-42 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
84-key Configuration Utility (for Windows XP/2000/NT/98)
Start
By default, the 84-key configuration utility is stored in the following directory on the hard disk:
C:\Program Files\Key Config\84keycfg.exe
You can start the 84-key configuration utility by double-clicking this file in Windows Explorer or
by selecting Program → Key Configuration Utilities → Configure 84 Keyboard
from the menu.
When the program starts, the following screen is displayed.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-43
Speed Buttons
Eleven speed buttons are displayed below the title bar for the 84-key configuration keytop
setting program. By clicking these speed buttons, you can call up the desired function quickly.
Exit
Load
New
Save
Code
Font
Label
Color
Prog
One
View
Prog
All
Print
Exit
Exits the 84-key keyboard configuration utility.
New
Clears the button’s function and creates a new setting.
Load
Loads a saved setting.
Save
Saves the current setting.
Label
Opens the key label dialog box.
Code
Opens the key code dialog box.
Color
Opens the color dialog.
Prog One
If you click this button while another button is selected, the utility
programs only the key for the selected button.
Prog All
The utility programs settings of all the buttons.
View
Opens the key view window and displays the keytops.
Print
Prints the current settings.
4-44 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Key Definitions
The keys on the screen correspond to the actual keytops on the keyboard unit. You define the
keytops using the following steps.
1. Click the key you want to code, and it becomes selected. (Clicking it again cancels the
selection.
2. Click the Code button to open the key code dialog box.
3. Input the code for the selected key from the keyboard. You can enter a code up to a
maximum of 64 bytes.)
When you select a key, if you hold down the Shift key and click the key immediately to the
right of or immediately below the selected key, the two keys are connected. By repeating this
procedure, a number of keys can be connected to create one large key. If you press the Shift
key while the connected key is selected, the connection is canceled.
4. If you click the OK button, the setting is made and the key code dialog is closed. If you click
the Cancel button, the setting is canceled. If you click the Reset button, the code is cleared.
Setting the Key Label
Use the following steps to label the keytop.
1. Click the key you want to label, and it becomes selected.
2. If you click the Label button, the key label dialog is opened.
3. Input any characters as the label.
4. If you click the OK button, the input characters are displayed on the button, and the key
label dialog closes. If you click the Cancel button, the input characters are canceled. Up to
20 characters can be input. “|” is regarded as a new line.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-45
Keytop Color Settings
Use the following steps to set the color of the keytop.
1. Click the key you want to color, and it becomes selected.
2. If you click the Color button, the color setting dialog is displayed.
3. Set the color of the keytop. (The color setting dialog uses the standard Windows function.
For details, see the Windows manual.)
4. If you click OK, the key is redrawn in the selected color, and the color setting dialog closes. If
you click the Cancel button, the selected color is canceled.
Key Program
To assign a setting to an actual key, you must run this program. You can run the program using
either of the following methods.
❏ Click the Prog One button while the button is selected. Only the selected key is
programmed.
❏ Click the Prog All button. All the keys are programmed.
If the program ends correctly, the following is displayed.
Saving the Settings
You can save the current settings as a file using the following procedure.
1. Click the Save button, and the “Save As” dialog is displayed. (This is the standard Windows
function. For details, see the Windows manual.)
2. If you input a file name and click the Save button, the settings are saved in a file. Use the file
extension “.K84.”
Loading the Settings
Load the settings using the following procedure.
1. If you click the Load button, the “Open” dialog is displayed. (This is the standard Windows
function. For details, see the Windows manual.)
2. If you select a file name and click the Load button, the selected settings are loaded.
4-46 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
New
To clear the current settings and create new settings, click the New button. All the key settings
are cleared.
Keytop View
If you click the View button, the key view window opens to let you confirm the labels and colors
of the keytops. You can change the size of the key view window by dragging one of its corners.
You can close the window by clicking the x button at the right end of the title bar.
Printing the Settings
To print the current settings use the following steps.
1. Click the Print button to display the print dialog. (This is the standard Windows function.
For details, see the Windows manual.)
2. If you click OK, the settings are printed.
Exit
If you click the Exit button, the 84-key keyboard configuration utility is exited.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-47
Automatic Definition Data Setting Utility (for Windows XP/2000/NT/98)
Function
When this utility is started, the firmware setting is converted into the setting described in the
file, and this utility is terminated.
Startup
The Automatic Definition Data Setting utility (PKLOAD32.EXE) has been copied in the directory
specified in the installation procedure. (If the directory was not specified, this utility has been
copied in the c:\Program Files\Key Config directory.)
This utility can be started by the following method:
❏ Enter as follows from the MS-DOS prompt:
[Path]PKLOAD32 filename [/n]
File name:
/n:
This is the pas name of the setting file for specifying the 28-key
keyboard/key lock setting file for Windows or the setting file for this
utility. (“***.k28,” “***.kyl” file)
When the [n] option is specified, the following dialog box is displayed at
the time of termination.
While the setting is being transferred, the dialog box indicating the situation is displayed. While
the 28-key keyboard/key lock setting file is being transferred, the following is displayed:
Writing Configuration #dd-d ...
where “dd” is the key number, and “d” is the number of retry times up to six.
While the setting file for this utility (see page 4-49) is being transferred, the following is
displayed:
Writing Configuration 0xhh-d ...
where “hh” is the character code when the MSR character conversion setting is in transfer or the
system conversion area is offset in hexadecimal in any other case, and “d” is the number of retry
times up to six.
4-48 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Note:
This utility is available only with an English message.
This utility cannot be used while the key definition utility, such as 28KeyCfg, is in programming.
There is no keyboard or mouse response during reading or writing of settings.
Do not perform any operation that may cause interruption, such as tapping on the touch panel, during
reading or writing of settings.
Setting File
An example of the setting file for this utility is shown below.
[General]
IgnoreCommands=Off
SystemParam00=49,0
SystemParam01=&32,&f7
[MSR]
Beep=On
CodeType=US
ValidTracks=1,2,3,J
CodeDefinition00=48,10
CodeDefinition01=&31,11,Shift
CodeDefinition02=&32,&0A,Ctrl
CardStart=CS
CardEnd=CE
Track1Start=1S
Track1End=1E
Track2Start=2S
Track2End=2E
Track3Start=3S
Track3End=3E
JIS2Start=JS
JIS2End = JE
In the General section, an entry line that may affect the entirety is described, in principle.
IgnoreCommands may be specified to be On. When it is specified to be On, the setting of the
keyboard or MSR cannot be read or written.
SystemParamxx is described when the data is written in the system conversion area. The
offset and data of the variable are divided with [,] for specification. These two can be
specified by the byte width in the form of decimal or hexadecimal or character. For the
decimal specification, it is described as it is. For the hexadecimal specification, & should be
prefixed. For the character, $ should be prefixed. SystemParamxx may be described in more
than one file by describing decimal in xx from 00 in order up to 99.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-49
In the MSR section, an entry that is related to the MSR is described.
Beep may be specified to be On or Off. When it is specified to be On, beep sounds while the
MSR is being read. When it is specified to be Off, beep does not sound while the MSR is
being read.
CodeType is specified to be US, JP, FR, GR, or SP. The key-in data created while the MSR
was being read becomes conformable to the keyboard array of the specified country.
ValidTracks is specified to be 1, 2, 3, or J. When it is specified to be 1, track 1 can be read.
When it is specified to be 2, track 2 can be read. When it is specified to be 3, track 3 can be
read. When it is specified to be J, the JIS2 track can be read. More than one file may be
specified by dividing them with ,.
CodeDefinitionxx is described to make the character created while the MSR was being read
original. The specification is made in order of character code, key number, and concurrent
pressing key information by dividing them with ,. If not required, the concurrent pressing
key information can be omitted. The character code and the key number are in the same
format as that of SystemParamxx. The concurrent pressing key information can be specified
to be Shift, Ctrl, and Alt. CodeDefinitionxx may also be described in more than one file. For
xx, specify the decimal in order from 00 up to 99.
CardStart, CadEnd, Track1Start, Track1End, Track2Start, Track2End, Track3Start,
Track3End, JIS2Start, and JIS2End are SSs/ESs for reading the MSR. Normal characters,
including space, can be described as they are. Special characters can be described as \xx,
where xx is a two-digit hexadecimal. Specifically, line feed, tab and \ (back slash) may be
described as \n, \t, and \\, respectively.
The line beginning with “;” is regarded only as a comment line. No comment may be
described at the right end of the entry line. Generally, no unnecessary space or tab may be
included.
Logon Tool (for Windows XP/2000/NT)
With the SEGina (SEIKO EPSON Image ID Authorization) tool, the users of Windows XP/2000
and and Windows NT 4.0 can use the software keyboard after logging on/off from the software
keyboard.
Data can be input in the windows in execution by clicking with the mouse the specific keys of
the software keyboard displayed on the screen The software keyboard can be moved by
dragging its upper part.
Restrictions for Windows 2000
When using the logon tool with Windows 2000, execute the Windows 2000 Service Pack2, and
then execute the registry setting file “ headless.reg” using the following procedure to change the
registry. The registry setting file is in the “C:\Backup\Logon” directory.
1. Double-click the headless.reg. The setting is applied.
2. When the system is restarted, the setting is valid.
4-50 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Installation
The instructions on the installation of this software are found in the Readme file in the
C:\Backup\Logon directory. For installation, use the following procedure:
1. Execute C:\backup\logon\Setup.exe. The Welcome dialog box is displayed. Click Next.
2. Specify the destination of the installation directory (C:\Program Files\EPSON\SEGina\
directory is the default). When Next is clicked, installation starts.
3. When installation is complete, the Setup Complete dialog box is displayed. Select Yes, and
click Finish to reboot the system.
CAUTION:
After installation of the SEGina in Windows NT 4.0 and Windows 2000, be sure to reboot
the system. If the Actinkey is executed without rebooting the system, trouble may occur.
If trouble occurs, reinstall the SEGina.
How to Use
The following three modules are installed:
SEGina—Controls logon with its main module
Logonkey—Software keyboard displayed at the time of logon
Actinkey—Software keyboard displayed after logon
In Windows NT 4.0, when the power to the system is turned on, the Logonkey is displayed
together with the Logon dialog box.
To use the software keyboard after the logon, select Actinkey from the Start menu. The Actinkey
menu is displayed.
When the check box at the top right is checked, the software keyboard is always displayed in the
upper part.
To exit Actinkey, click the upper right X.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-51
Do not use this tool for the hardware keyboard or it may respond with the wrong keyboard
status. The tool is applicable to the 101/102/106-key keyboards; however, the operation cannot
be guaranteed when the OS is not in Japanese or English.
EPSON OPOS ADK
OLE (Object Linkage and Embedding) is component software that runs on the OS of Win 32-bit
style, such as Microsoft Windows NT 4.0. Depending on how the software components have
been created, the software may be reusable or reversely compatible.
The objective of the OLE POS (“OPOS”) is to use the OLE to standardize the control system
(API) for the peripheral units of the POS. By this standardization, the application and peripheral
unit control software become open and generic. The OPOS standardizes the interface between
the POS application and the device control object, which depends on the device or the
manufacturer. The OPOS also facilitates the transplant of the application and the
reconfiguration of the peripheral devices.
Because of standardization of the peripheral devices, a large part of the work required for the
development of software can be eliminated, and the system can become fully open. As a result,
comparatively small-sized shops that plan to introduce the POS can easily configure an
intelligent, flexible POS system.
OPOS makes it easy to build POS applications that take advantage of the functionality that
Windows has to offer, such as graphics, video, and sound; a user-friendly GUI; and
multitasking.
For information on the installation procedure for the OPOS ADK, see the user’s guide registered
in the \C:\Backup\Oposadk directory.
Creating the Component Software
The POS device needs a control program. The device control object once existed as a part of
monolithic POS application software. Because of this monolithic structure, POS system
designers had to replace or change the entire POS application software to change the device
control object alone when a peripheral device was replaced. This work claimed a lot of time and
money. POS application software developers had to become experts about each manufacturer’s
devices, including functions and command systems, to create a device control object.
With the advent of the PC-POS, however, any external device is now connectable to a PC as long
as the interface (serial, parallel, or whatever) is supported. While the problem with the
compatibility of the hardware was solved in this way, a problem with the software still existed.
The software was not applicable, and the POS application software itself had to be replaced. For
this reason, it was impossible to make the PC-POS fully open in terms of both the hardware and
software.
To solve this problem, the device control object was modularized and made to be independent
of the POS application software. Because only the device control object needs replacement at this
time, the work to replace the POS application software itself when the device was replaced is
simplified. Also, because the original device control object is supplied, the POS application
4-52 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
software developers no longer need the detailed expertise of each manufacturer’s device or the
standardization of the entire system and the hardware as well as the software. This reduces the
load of developing work.
Software Standardization
When a device control object is created, it is necessary to choose the interface (API) between the
POS application software and the device control module. EPSON has joined an industrywide
and worldwide effort to standardize and spread the use of APIs. The standardized software uses
an OCX driver, which is modularized software divided into two levels: the Control Object (CO)
and the Service Object (SO).
A separate CO exists for each class of device, while a separate SO exists for each individual
device; for example, software that uses a TM-U950 needs a general POS printer CO and a
specific TM-U950 SO. If the TM-U950 printer were replaced by a TM-U375 printer, the TM-U950
SO would have to be replaced by a TM-U375 SO, but the rest of the software, including the POS
printer CO, would remain the same. In other words, a switch from one printer to another
requires only a change in the SO.
EPSON Software
The software products (OCX drivers) that EPSON offers to enable such an OPOS system are
called the EPSON OPOS ADK. The EPSON OPOS ADK provides the OCX driver and much
more. EPSON also provides custom tools to support the construction and development of an
OPOS application software development environment.
Keyboard Firmware Setting Utility for MS-DOS
The Keyboard Firmware Setting utility (PKMODE2.EXE) sets the POS board built in the IR-320.
By using this utility, the keyboard firmware and the MSR unit can be set.
Start
The Keyboard Firmware Setting utility (PKMODE2.EXE) has been registered in the following
directory in the initial setting:
c:\backup\keycfg\Dos\Pkmode2.exe
Prepare a floppy disk of MS-DOS that can be booted, and copy this utility onto this floppy disk.
To start the Keyboard Firmware Setting utility, exit Windows, and reboot the system from
MS-DOS. By inputting the command name from the keyboard, the utility starts.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-53
Note:
To execute this utility, be sure to exit Windows, and reboot the system from MS-DOS beforehand. This
utility cannot be executed from the DOS box.
To use the MSR unit, execute this utility or the Keyboard Firmware Setting utility for Windows, and set
the track to be read. To make the JIS2 type card readable, execute the following command:
PKMODE2 MSR=12J
Commands
Run the utility by typing the command in the following format:
PKMODE2.EXE[MSR1|MSR3|MSR] [US|JP|FR|GR|SP] [CMDOFF|CMDON]
[TK0SS=string] [TK0ES=string] [TK1SS=string] [TK1ES=string]
[TK2SS=string] [TK2ES=string] [TK3SS=string] [TK3ES=string]
[TKJSS=string] [TKJES=string] [BEEP=ON|BEEP=OFF] [MSR=m...]
[KEYTBL=pathname] [/TRACE] [/TRON] [/TROFF]
[/VAL=xxh,yyh] [/PARA[zzh]]
Description of parameters:
MSR1:
MSR3:
MSR:
US:
JP:
FR:
GR:
SP:
CMDOFF:
CMDON:
4-54 Utilities
Prohibits decoding for Track 3. Set when the DM-MR111-012 is
mounted.
Prohibits decoding for Track 1. Set when the DM-MR111-013 is
mounted.
Sets the MSR unit decode to enable the 3-track decodes for Track 1,
Track 2, and Track 3. Sets the DM-MR123 when it is selected.
Responds with the MSR data in the scan code of the English 101-key
keyboard (default value).
Responds with the MSR data in the scan decode of the Japanese 106-key
keyboard.
Responds with the MSR data in the scan decode of the French 106-key
keyboard.
Responds with the MSR data in the scan decode of the German 106-key
keyboard.
Responds with the MSR data in the scan decode of the Spanish 106-key
keyboard. This country setting is effective also for the default key setting
of the 28-key keyboard. The specification of FR/GR/SP cannot be used
for the IR-300.
Outputs all commands to the external K/B, neglecting the K/B interface
command. Sets such things as the programming of the POS keyboard
connected to the external K/B before executing them. According to this
setting, the command cannot be executed until it is reset or the power is
turned off. The CMDOFF is cancelled, however, when it is reset or the
power to the main body is turned off, and the CMDON status is
resumed.
Accepts the command of the K/B interface (default value).
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
TK0SS=string:
Replaces the start flag in the MSR card unit with the string. The default
is “ “ (none).
TK0ES=string:
Replaces the end flag in the MSR card unit with the string. The default is
“ “ (none).
TK1SS=string:
Replaces the 1track start flag of the MSR with the string. The default is
“%.”
TK1ES=string:
Replaces the 1track end flag of the MSR with the string. The default is
“?.”
TK2SS=string:
Replaces the 2track start flag of the MSR with the string. The default is
“;.”
TK2ES=string:
Replaces the 2track end flag of the MSR with the string. The default is
“?.”
TK3SS=string:
Replaces the 3track start flag of the MSR with the string. The default is
“+.”
TK3ES=string:
Replaces the 3track end flag of the MSR with the string. The default is
“?.”
TKJSS=string:
Replaces the JIS II type start flag of the MSR with the string. The default
is “ “ (20th).
TKJES=string:
Replaces the JIS II type end flag of the MSR with the string. The default
is “%” (7th).
BEEP=ON:
Enables the buzzer sound when the magnetic card is read. This is the
default setting. When the magnetic card is read in order, the buzzer
sounds once. When an error is caused to the magnetic card reading, the
buzzer sounds three times. The LED lights up at the same time.
BEEP=OFF:
Invalidates the sound loaded from the card with the MSR123 and only
illuminates the LED.
MSR=m...:
Specifies the track that enables the MSR decode. The following four
characters can be specified:
“1”: ISO/JIS1 type Track 1
“2”: ISO/JIS1 type Track 2
“3”: ISO/JIS1 type Track 3
“J”: JIS2 type
When the same character is specified more than once, an error is caused.
The default is “123.” “MSR1” is “MSR=12,” and “MSR3” is “MSR=23.”
KEYTBL=pathname: Sets the scan code conversion table for converting the MSR data into the
scan code. This is used for any keyboard other than the U.S. 101-key
keyboard and the Japan 106-key keyboard.
/TRACE:
Displays the trace information to the standard output. For example, this
can be saved in a file by using the redirect.
/TRON:
Enables the trace function.
/TROFF:
Disables the trace function (default value).
/VAL=xxh, yyh:
Sets variable xxh to the yyh address of the system.
/PARA[zzh]:
Displays the values of the system variables from 00h to FFh. When zzh is
specified, the SRAM values from zz00h to zzFFh are displayed.
More than one parameter can be specified together, however, the parameters with “/” and the
parameters without “/” cannot be specified together.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-55
The parameters are analyzed and executed one by one. When an invalid parameter is specified,
an error to that effect is displayed, and the next parameter is analyzed. Even if an error is caused,
the processing does not cease.
The value set under this command is written into the K/B firm unless it is in the CMDOFF
status; therefore, the setting cannot be deleted by turning on the power.
Processing Details
The version is displayed as Firmware Version= V3.00. To obtain detailed version information,
execute PKUPDT2.EXE.
Note:
This utility is started from and executed on MS-DOS. (It cannot be executed from the DOS box.)
This utility uses the K/B interface for communication with the firmware. For this reason, do not operate
the 28-key keyboard, the KeyLock, and the MSR as well as the external keyboard during the execution or
an error is caused during the data communication, and this utility cannot start in order.
Do not reset the system or switch the power supply off when this utility is in operation.
When the CMDOFF is set, the command cannot be executed unless it is reset or the power to the main
body is turned off.
Messages
The following message is displayed when the utility starts.
EPSON POS Keyboard Configuration Utility Vx.xx.xx
Firmware Version= Vx.xx.xx
4-56 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
As parameters execute correctly, the following messages are displayed:
POS key status messages
Parameter
Message
MSR1
MSR track1
MSR3
MSR track3
MSR
MSR default
US
US 101 keyboard
JP
JP 106 keyboard
FR
French keyboard
GR
German keyboard
SP
Spanish keyboard
CMDOFF
Command Function OFF
CMDON
Command Function ON
TK0SS
Card Start Sentinel = string
TK0ES
Card End Sentinel = string
TR?SS
Track? Start Sentinel = string
TK?ES
Track? End Sentinel = string
TKJSS
JIS2 Start Sentinel = string
TKJES
JIS2 End Sentinel = string
BEEP=ON
MSR Beep ON
BEEP=OFF
MSR Beep OFF
MSR=m..
MSR track m..
KEYTBL
Set KeyTable
/TRACE, /TRON, /TROFF
See [ ]
/VAL=
Set Addr[VAL]=xxh[yyh]
/PARA, /CODE, /DATA
*** Parameter Dump ***
ADDR: +0 +1 +2 +3 +4 +5 +6 +7 +8 +9 +A +B +C +D +E +F
0123456789ABCDEF
0000: 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 - 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F ................
0010: 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 - 38 39 3A 3B 3C 3D 3E 3F
0123456789:;<=>?
....
00E0: 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 - 48 49 4A 4B 4C 4D 4E 4F
@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNO
00F0: 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 - 58 59 5A 5B 5C 5D 5E 5F
PQRSTUVWXYZ[\]^_
KEYL
KeyLock Position
/KEY=
SetKey data=ii ofs=jj num=kk
* ? is 1, 2, or 3.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-57
Error messages are shown below:
POS key error messages
Message
Description
Firmware version is not correct
Firmware version error, and others
Invalid parameter
Parameter error
Communication error
Communication error
Invalid pathname
Pathname error
28-Key Configuration Utility for MS-DOS
The 28-key configuration utility for MS-DOS can define the keys and Shift+keys on the 28-key
keyboard unit connected to the IR-320 in MS-DOS.
This program has been preinstalled in the following directory:
C:/Backup/Keycfg/DOS/
This program is stored on the floppy disk that comes with the 28-key keyboard unit and is
installed on the hard disk by executing the install program.
Key definitions
Number of definitions
21 characters maximum per key
(Shift/Ctrl/Alt/Gray are each handled as one character)
Operation
Keyboard (mouse not available)
Functions
File
1. Designating a key-definition file
Load
2. Reading data from a key-definition file
Save
3. Writing data to a key-definition file
Edit
4. Editing a key-definition file
Download
5. Writing defined keys to the keyboard
See the table “Definable keys” on page 4-60 for the keys that can be defined.
Note:
Do not input from the keyboard while the defined keys are being written to the keyboard.
Start
During installation, the key definition utility for MS-DOS (POSKB28.EXE) is copied into the
specified directory. If no directory is specified, the utility is copied into the C:\POSKB directory.
Start this program as follows:
1. Exit Windows, and restart the system in DOS mode.
2. At the DOS prompt, type POSKB28, and press Enter.
4-58 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
3. When this program starts, the following screen appears.
How to Operate
Initial Screen
Select the button with the arrow buttons (← and →, ↑ and ↓), and press Enter to execute the
command.
File
This key is used to specify the key definition file name. Enter the file name, and press Enter. To
cancel, press Esc.
Load
This key is used to read the data from the key definition file specified by the File button.
Save
This key is used to save the data under the key definition file name specified by the File button.
Edit
This key is used to edit the key definition by using the following procedure:
1. The 28 keys are displayed on the screen in the same array as the keyboard unit. Select the
key to be edited with the ←, →, ↑, and ↓ keys, and press Enter to start the editing.
2. Press the keys one by one according to the contents of the key to be defined. The key
definition contents are displayed in order of inputting in the New column in the lower part
of the screen. The previous key definition contents are displayed in the Old column.
3. When Alt + Ctrl is pressed, the process retraces the inputted key contents by one key
contents. When Ctrl + Shift is pressed, the key definition is fixed, and the Key Selection
screen is displayed again. When Shift + Shift is pressed, the inputted key definition is
cancelled, and the Key Selection screen is displayed again.
4. The key top of the edited key is displayed in red.
5. To exit the editing on the Key Selection screen, press Esc.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-59
Download
This key is used to actually write the defined key contents in the keyboard. When Download is
executed, the key contents are written from 1 in order. After writing is completed, the following
message is displayed:
Key map Download O.K., Press any key to Continue...
When any key is pressed, the initial screen is displayed.
Quit
This key is used to exit this utility.
For information on the definable keys, see the table “Definable keys” below.
❏ The file name set at the File command is saved in K28_DL.CFG as the key definition data
when this utility is finished.
List of Definable Keys
Following is a list of definable keys with the supplied utilities. “Yes” means “can be defined”;
“No” means “cannot be defined” in the table below.
Definable keys
Utility
POSKB28.EXE
OS
DOS
Language
U.S. mode
Keyboard
101 series
Keys that cannot be defined,
depending on OS
Print Screen, Scroll Lock, Pause, Num Lock, Caps Lock, Ctrl+Alt+Del,
Shift, Alt, Ctrl
Limits on key combinations
Single
Shift
Ctrl
Alt
Esc
Yes
No
No
Yes
Fn (Function Key)
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
13457890
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
26
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
a-z
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Tab
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
BS
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Space
Yes
No
No
No
Enter
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
-[]¥
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
=;’‘,./
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Ins
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Del
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
4-60 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Definable keys (continued)
Home
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
End
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
PageUp
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
PageDown
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
↑
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
↓
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
→
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
←
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
/ * (Ten key)
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
- + (Ten key)
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Enter (Ten key)
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
0 . 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 (Ten key)
Yes
No
Yes
No
84-key Configuration Utility (for MS-DOS)
You can use the key configuration utility for MS-DOS to define keys of the KeyLock keys and 84key keyboard connected to the IR-310/320 in MS-DOS.
The version of the utilities is renewed.
The compatibility of the 84-Key Configuration Utility (for MS-DOS) and the keyboard firmware
Keyboard firmware
3.00
3.03
POSKB.exe Ver.2.11
OK
OK
POSKB.exe Ver.2.00
OK
NG
Key definitions
Number of definitions
84 keys and 6-position key lock keys.
16 or 21 characters maximum per key. *
(Shift/Ctrl/Alt/Gray are each handled as one character.)
Operation
Keyboard (mouse not available).
Functions
File
1. Designating a key-definition file
Load
2. Reading data from a key-definition file
Save
3. Writing data to a key-definition file
Edit
4. Editing a key-definition file
Download
5. Writing defined keys to the keyboard
* 21 Character :Than version 2.11 newer
Rev. C
Utilities 4-61
Start
The key definition utility for DOS is stored in the following directory by default:
C:\Program Files\Key Config\poskb.exe
(In DOS mode, this file is shown as C:\progra~1\keycon~1\poskb.exe)
To execute this utility, quit Windows and restart the IR-310/320 in the DOS mode. Type the
command name on the keyboard and the following screen is displayed.
Basic Operations
The utility has the five command buttons below:
File
Names the file. Key definitions are saved or loaded using the file name created
with this function.
Load
Loads the key-definition data file you specify.
Save
Writes key-definition data to the disk file named by the file function.
Edit
Edits key definitions one key at a time.
Download
Writes the key-definition data to the keyboard memory. The keyboard data does
not change until the key-definition data is downloaded.
Select the command with the right or left arrow key, and press Enter to execute it. To exit the
program, select Quit.
File Command
When you select File, the following screen is displayed.
4-62 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
The file command defines a key-definition file name for Load and Save operations.
This file name must use MS-DOS file name format (8-character name + 3-character extension).
You can edit the file name with Backspace, Delete, and arrow keys.
Press Enter to confirm the file name or ESC to cancel.
When you exit this utility, the file name defined by the File command is saved in the
KBD_DL.CFG file.
When the utility is booted up next, the name of the file containing the key-definition data is read
from KBD_DL.CFG.
Load Command
When you select the Load command, the following screen is displayed.
Press Enter to read the key-definition data from the file created by the File command.
Save Command
When you select the Load command, the following screen is displayed.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-63
Press Enter to save the key-definition data to the file created by the File command.
Edit Command
When you select Edit, the following screen is displayed.
Press Enter to switch to the screen below.
4-64 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
The highlighted key on the screen is the key being edited, and the current definition of the key is
displayed in the bottom part of the screen in the “Old” row. Press the arrow keys to select the
key to be edited; then press Enter to switch to the next screen.
M0 to M6 indicate the key lock keys.
Enter the definition for the selected key. Your definition is displayed in the “New” row.
Use the definition keys below to edit the key definitions.
Alt + Ctrl
Delete the previous key definition.
Shift + Shift
Delete input data and revert to the definition before the key was
selected.
Ctrl + Shift
Save the input data. The keytop changes to show that the key has
been defined.
Press ESC to quit the Edit menu.
Download Command
When you select DownLoad, the following screen is displayed.
Press Enter to switch to the screen below.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-65
While data is transmitted, the following message is shown at the bottom of the screen.
Download keyboard map, wait please...
Note
Do not enter data from the keyboard during a download.
Quit Command
When you select Quit, the following screen is displayed.
Press Enter to quit this program.
You can also exit the program by pressing the ESC key, but when you press ESC, the file name
created with the File command is not saved.
Error Messages
The program displays the following error messages.
During boot-up
Invalid key configuration format – Press any key to continue...
A data inconsistency exists in the key conversion file (KEYTABLE.DEF). Check the data.
4-66 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Scan code table overflow – Press any key to continue...
Too much key-definition data exists in the key conversion file (KEYTABLE.DEF). Limit the
data to the required items.
Load command
File not exist. Press any key to end...
The file designated by the File command does not exist. Check the file name.
File format error. Press any key to end...
Abnormal key-definition data. Check the file name.
Save command
File create error. Press any key to end...
Could not save the key-definition data. Check the free capacity on the hard disk drive.
Download command
Key map download Fail – Time Out. Press any key to continue...
Could not write the key-definition data to the keyboard.
Upload command
Key map upload Fail – Time Out. Press any key to continue...
Could not read the key-definition data to the keyboard.
Automatic Definition Data Setting Utility (For MS-DOS)
Outline
This utility automatically sets the definition information of the POS keyboard of the IR-320.
Command
Execute the command in the following format:
PKLOAD.EXE data-file
Processing Details
This utility automatically sets the following data:
Rev. C
•
Saving file for Windows version 28-key definition (.K28)
•
Saving file for Windows version 84-key definition (.K84)
•
Saving file for Windows version KeyLock definition (.KYL)
Utilities 4-67
•
Setting file for this utility (.PKL)
Be sure to specify the extension of the specified file because the effectiveness of the specified file
is checked with its extension. The download function of the upload file is realized by
PKUPDT2.EXE.
Note:
This utility is started from and executed on MS-DOS. (It cannot be executed from the DOS box.)
This utility uses the K/B interface for communication with the firmware. For this reason, do not operate
the 28-key keyboard, the KeyLock, the MSR, or the external keyboard during the execution or an error is
caused during the data communication, and this utility cannot start in order.
Do not reset this utility or turn off the power to the main body during the execution of this utility.
Messages
Messages
Message
Description
EPSON POS Keyboard Auto Definition Utility Vx.xx.xx
During startup
Usage:
PKLOAD data-file
data-file: definition data file
.K84 :84Key definition data
.K28 :28Key definition data
.KYL :KeyLock definition data
.$$$ :PKUPLD saved data
.FLD :PKUPLD2 saved data
.PKL :PKMODE definition data
Usage
EPSON POS Keyboard Auto Definition Utility Vx.xx.xx
Now transfer 28Key Definition data .........
28-key definition data transfer
EPSON POS Keyboard Auto Definition Utility Vx.xx.xx
Now transfer 84Key Definition data .........
84-key definition data transfer
EPSON POS Keyboard Auto Definition Utility Vx.xx.xx
Now transfer KeyLock Definition data .........
Key lock definition data transfer
The message like that of PKMODE.EXE is displayed.
For information, see the table “POS key status messages” on
page 4-57.
PKMODE definition data transfer
Error messages
Message
Description
Firmware version error and others
Firmware version error and others
Invalid parameter
Parameter error
Firmware communication error
Firmware communication error
File access error: No such file or directory
File access error
4-68 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Ending Codes
Ending codes
Ending code
Description
0
Normal termination
10
Wrong firm version or execution on other PC (abnormal termination)
11
Parameter error (abnormal termination)
14
Error in communication with the firmware (abnormal termination)
20
Error during file access (abnormal termination)
21
Abnormal file data format (abnormal termination)
File Format
The setting file for this utility is created by using a text editor or other device. The extension of
this file should be specified as [.PKL]. The format has the following sections and entries:
File format
Section
Entry
Parameter
(underlined parameters
are the default values)
[General]
Fixed value. Be sure to describe at the start.
Version
PKL100
Fixed value. Be sure to describe at the start.
IgnoreCommands
Selected from Off and On
Be careful that if On is selected, the subsequent
commands are not accepted.
SystemParam00
Rev. C
Remarks
Set in the Offset and Value formats.
00h < Offset ≤ FFh, 00h ≤ Value ≤ FFh
Utilities 4-69
File format (continued)
Section
Entry
Parameter
(underlined parameters
are the default values)
ValidTracks
Selected from 1, 2, and 3
Beep
On, Off
CodeType
US, JP, FR, GR, SP
Remarks
[MSR]
CardStart
CardEnd
Selection of more than one value may be
selected.
For information on input enabled characters, see
SS/ES Code Input Enabled Characters.
Track1Start
[<, >, |] are characters and can be input.
Track1End
Input the hexadecimal as [\nn] within a range
from [01h] to [7Fh].
Track2Start
Track2End
Effective up to 7 characters. The 8th character
and those thereafter are neglected.
Track3Start
Track3End
JIS2Start
Because even the line-feed character is
effective, do not carelessly input a space or a
tab.
JIS2End
CodeDefinition00
See “Code Conversion Entry” on page 4-71 for
further details.
When nothing is described after the entry, the entry setting is deleted.
For Sysparam00 and CodeDefinition00, set numeric numbers in a range from 00 to 99. Set the numeric values one
by one in ascending order. Do not input the same numeric value for more than one.
The default setting (U.S. mode) is described as follows:
[General]
Version=PKL100
IgnoreCommands=Off
[MSR]
ValidTracks=1,2,3
Beep=On
CodeType=US
CardStart=
CardEnd=
Track1Start=%
Track1End=?
Track2Start=;
Track2End=?
Track3Start=+
Track3End=?
4-70 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Code Conversion Entry
CodeDefinitionNN = Character Code, Key Number, Shift Mode
CodeDefinitionNN
Character Code
Key Number
Shift Mode
Shift
Control
Alt
: Specifies the character code to be defined. 'c' defines whether a character
or numeral has been specified. Example: 'A' 0x41 65
: Sets values between 01h and 7Fh
: Specifies the key numbers shown in the table below
: Concurrent pressing key information
: Used for the scan codes with the Shift key
: Used for the scan codes with the Ctrl key
: Used for the scan codes with the Alt key
List of key numbers (keys shaded in gray cannot be set)
Power Management Driver APM2.0
When this driver is installed, the following power management functions become available:
•
Turning off the power to the system after shutting down Windows NT
•
Notification that the front power switch was pressed
•
Notification that the AC power is abnormal
The Power Management Driver APM2.0 is attached to the battery unit (OI-R03-021).
Installation
When the driver has not yet been installed, install it by using the following procedure.
Note:
Install the driver after completion of all setting work for Windows NT, including the Service Pack.
Leave the installation work for the driver to a user qualified as an administrator.
1. Exit all applications under execution.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-71
2. Insert the floppy disk attached to the OI-R03 into the floppy disk drive of the IR-320.
3. Execute APM32.EXE on the floppy disk.
4. The following dialog box for specifying the destination of extraction is displayed. Confirm
the destination of extraction, and click Unzip. Then, the Setup program is extracted into the
specified directory.
5. After the extraction, the Termination dialog box is displayed. Click OK to close the
Termination dialog box.
6. The following Setup screen is displayed.
7. Confirm the directory into which the driver should be installed, and click Setup. To change
the directory, click Change Directory, and specify the destination of the installation
directory.
8. When Setup is clicked, installation of the driver starts.
9. After completion of the setup, the following screen is displayed. Click OK.
4-72 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
10. The screen prompts you to reboot. Click Restart Now, and reboot the OS. The driver
becomes available after rebooting.
Confirmation
After rebooting the OS, check whether the driver has been installed properly by using the
following procedure:
1. Confirm that the power plug icon is displayed on the task bar.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-73
Notes for Use
❏ When the power plug icon on the task bar or APM2.0 for NT on the control panel is
double-clicked, the following setting screen is displayed. Click OK without changing the
setting to exit the setting screen.
❏ To conceal the power plug icon on the task bar, select the Settings tab on the above setting
screen, uncheck the Show Icon in Taskbar check box, and click OK. The power plug icon
disappears from the task bar.
4-74 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Reference
The following events occur when the front switches using the environment provided by this
driver are operated (Front Switch Operation) and the AC power error is detected (AC Fail):
1. Occurrence of AC Fail (AC Offline) event or Front Switch Operation
2. Notification of AC Offline Status caused by the APM BIOS
3. Acceptance of AC Offline Status Notify by the driver
4. Notification of WM_POWERBROADCAST from the driver to the application
5. Termination processing by the application itself
6. Execution of WinNT Shutdown by using the ExitWindowsEx function
7. Execution of Auto Power of the system by the APM BIOS after WinNT Shutdown
By using the WM_POWERBROADCAST notification from the driver, the processing can be
performed from the normal shutdown of Windows NT to the power off.
The following shows easy sample codes. In practical operation, the shutdown should be
performed after terminating all applications.
LRESULT CALLBACK WndProc(HWND hWnd, UINT Message, WPARAM wParam,
LPARAM lParam)
{
HWND
hTmpWnd;
HBRUSH
hTmpBrush;
HANDLE
htkProcess;
OKEN_PRIVILEGES tkPriv;
UINT
uFlags = EWX_SHUTDOWN;
switch(Message)
{
case WM_POWERBROADCAST:
OpenProcessToken(GetCurrentProcess(),
TOKEN_ADJUST_PRIVILEGES, &htkProcess);
tkPriv.PrivilegeCount = 1;
LookupPrivilegeValue(NULL, SE_SHUTDOWN_NAME, &tkPriv.Privileges[0].Luid);
tkPriv.Privileges[0].Attributes = SE_PRIVILEGE_ENABLED;
AdjustTokenPrivileges(htkProcess, FALSE, &tkPriv, 0, NULL, NULL);
ExitWindowsEx(EWX_POWEROFF, 0);
break;
default:
return DefWindowProc(hWnd, Message, wParam, lParam);
}
return 0L;
Rev. C
Utilities 4-75
AC Line Tool (For Windows 2000/98)
The AC Line Tool is used to send a notification to the application that the system power has
been changed from the AC Line to the battery drive in Windows 2000/98. When the optional
battery unit (OI-R03-021) is attached, if the AC Line is cut due to a power cut, the power is
changed to be supplied by the battery unit. When this happens, the tool displays a message that
encourages the user to save the data at the application side and the tool enables programming to
exit the application.
Note:
This tool cannot be used in Windows NT.
Installation
Note:
Only a user who has administrative authority can install it.
Follow the steps below for the installation.
1. Execute C:\backup\epsbatt\Epsbatt.exe. The Welcome dialog appears. Click Next.
2. When the installation is finished, the Reboot dialog appears. Select “Yes, I want to restart my
computer now.” and click Finish.
3. The system is rebooted and the tool is automatically started.
Uninstallation
Follow the steps below for uninstallation.
1. Open [Control Panel].
2. Select [Add/Remove Applications].
3. Select [EPSON AC Line watching] from the list of software installed and click the [Add/
Remove] button.
4. The dialog to confirm the uninstallation appears. Click [OK] to execute the uninstallation.
Usage
If you install the tool, when the system power is switched from the AC Line to the battery drive,
it transmits [WM_POWERBROADCAST] and [PBT_APMPOWERSTATUSCHANGE] to all the
windows.
Startup
If you install the tool, when the sytem set to the registry starts up, the tool is set to start up
automatically. When the tool starts up, the icon appears in the task tray.
4-76 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Exit
Right-click the icon on the task tray and select Exit from the pop-up menu to exit the tool.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-77
Power Button Tool (For Windows 2000)
This tool is used to set the registry so that neither the shut down mode or stand-by mode can be
entered even if the front power switch is pressed. This can prevent the system shut down due to
an incorrect operation of the front power switch.
Notes on usage
If you update the [Power Control] of Windows, the settings are cleared. Therefore, be sure to set
the settings after updating it.
Usage
1. Execute C:\backup\dissw\DISSW.EXE.
2. The following message appears. Click [Yes].
3. When the registery is set, the following message appears. Clicking [Yes] reboots Windows
and the settings are available. Clicking [No] returns to Windows without the settings being
available. In this case, if you reboot Windows, the settings are available.
BaySwap
Once you install the BaySwap software, you can insert and remove CompactFlash cards while
the IM-320 is in operation. BaySwap can only be used under Windows NT.The software must
first be installed from the floppy disk supplied if it is to be used.
4-78 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
After installation, the BaySwap icon will reside in the task bar, as shown below, when Windows
NT is booted.
Operation procedure
Check to ascertain that reading and writing is not being performed on the compact flash before
detaching it.
1. Perform a left-hand click on the icon in the task bar, and then click on [Change device in
Swappabe Bay].
2. The following dialog box will be displayed. Attach or detach the card at this point.
3. Click on the [OK] button once the card has been attached or detached.
Rev. C
Utilities 4-79
4-80 Utilities
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Chapter 5
BIOS Functions
The IR-320 system ROM stores the following BIOS-related utilities. This chapter describes the
BIOS setup utility and Power on self-test (POST).
❏ BIOS setup
❏ Power on self-test (POST)
❏ Device diagnostic utility (See Chapter 6)
Restrictions
When using Windows 2000, the quitting of the application and the Auto Shutdown of OS cannot
be done by using the Power Status Change Notification.
The AC Line Tool utility is provided to send a notification to the application that the system power has
been changed from the AC Line to the battery drive. See Chapter 4, “Utility” for details.
HDD Power Down Timer Setting
The HDD Power Down Timer settings are made through the OS in Windows XP/2000/98, but
in Windows NT/95 and DOS, the settings are made through the BIOS, as detailed below. To
have the HDD motor stop when the HDD is not accessed for a certain time, follow the steps
below:
1. Start up the BIOS Setup Utility.
2. Select [Power Management Setup].
3. Select [HDD Power Down].
4. Select the time in the option.
5. Save it and restart.
After the restart, when there is no HDD access for the time set, the HDD Power Down Timer
switches over to HDD Power Down and the motor of the HDD stops.
Note:
This function can be used only with BIOS version 2.11.02 or higher. If your BIOS version is before
2.11.01, upgrade the BIOS and then do the above procedure.
When access to HDD occurs, the motor of HDD begins to start and the HDD becomes accessible.
Rev.C
5-1 BIOS Functions
BIOS Setup
The BIOS setup menu utility is used to configure the system’s operating environment. When
setting up this product for the first time, be sure to run this program. If you change the operating
environment, run this program again.
Operating Procedure
How to use setup
To execute BIOS setup requires a PS/2-compatible keyboard. BIOS setup cannot be run from the
touch panel alone.
Start the BIOS setup utility using the following procedure:
1. Connect the keyboard to the keyboard connector.
2. Turn the power on to start up the IR-320.
3. Press Del during the POST process, and the BIOS setup utility will start up.
How to exit
Follow the steps below to enable your changes for a new configuration and to exit the BIOS
setup utility:
1. Display the BIOS setup main menu.
2. Select Save & Exit Setup, and press Enter.
3. The message SAVE to CMOS and EXIT (Y/N)? is displayed. Press Y and Enter in this
order to exit the BIOS setup utility, validate the changed settings, and reboot the system.
Follow the procedure below to cancel changes and exit the BIOS setup utility.
1. Display the BIOS setup main menu.
2. Select Exit Without Saving, and press Enter.
3. The message Quit Without Saving (Y/N)? is displayed. Press Y and Enter.
4. The BIOS setup utility finishes, and the system reboots with the new configuration canceled.
CAUTION:
Do not change the settings of any items other than those specified in this manual. Do
not change the settings of any items for which “Do not change” is specified in this
manual. If an incorrect setting is made, the IR-320 may not operate.
5-2 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Troubleshooting
After the BIOS Setup utility has been used, the computer may be not able to be started up
normally because of changes made.
When the BIOS Setup utility can be started up, execute the Load Optimized Default from the
BIOS setup utility, save & exit, and then restart the system.
When the BIOS Setup utility cannot be started up, clear the CMOS with the jamper. Clear the
CMOS by shorting 2-3 of JP5. For details, see Chapter 1 “Jumper Locations and Settings.”
Changing settings
To choose an item, first move the cursor onto a desired field with the arrow keys. Next, select a
value in the field with + (PageUp) or – (PageDown). Finally, select the Save & Exit Setup
command in the main menu, which saves the currently displayed values of all the menus.
Rev.C
5-3 BIOS Functions
BIOS Setup Main Menu
The BIOS setup main menu contains the following items:
Table 5-1 BIOS setup main menu
Item
Contents
Standard CMOS Features
Basic BIOS setup menu
[See Table 5-2]
Advanced BIOS Features
Extended BIOS setup menu
[See Table 5-3]
Advanced Chipset Features
These features set items related to chipset. Since these settings are executed via
the Load Optimized Defaults, they are the optimum settings for the system and
generally do not need to be changed.
[See Table 5-4]
Integrated Peripherals
Its items for controlling the input and output for the IDE controller, the USB
controller, the parallel port, and the serial port.
[See Table 5-5]
Power Management Setup
Sets items related to BIOS based power regulation of the power management
timer, wake-up event and timer reset event.
[See Table 5-6]
PnP/PCI Configurations
Sets items related to system resource allocation of IRQ numbers and DMA channel
numbers. generally do not need to be changed. Default setting is Auto.
[See Table 5-7]
Frequency/Voltage Control
it only displays items and no selection can be made.
Load Fail-Safe Defaults
The load fail-Safe defaults are executed when the minimum preset prescribed
values required for the startup are set for each item. This function is only provided
for troubleshooting and is normally not used.
Load Optimized Defaults
The load optimized defaults are executed when preset prescribed values are set
for each item so that the system operates under optimum conditions. It is also
executed when the “CMOS checksum error - Defaults Loaded” message is
displayed and each item is restored to its prescribed value.
Set Supervisor Password
This function sets the system protection password. The password can be set for up
to 8 characters (case-sensitive). The input demand timing for the password setting
differs according to the setting for Advanced BIOS Features: Security Option.
[See Password Setting]
Set User Password
This function sets the system protection password. The password can be set for up
to 8 characters (case-sensitive). The input demand timing for the password setting
differs according to the setting for Advanced BIOS Features: Security Option.
[See Password Setting]
Save & Exit Setup
This is executed at restart after saving CMOS content changes.
Exit Without Saving
This is executed at restart without saving CMOS changes (cleared).
5-4 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Standard CMOS Features Menu
In this menu, set the system clock and the calendar, set the disk drive parameters and the type of
video subsystem, select among the error types that interrupt the power on self-test (POST), and
so on.
Table 5-2 Standard CMOS Features menu
Rev.C
Items
Description
Date
Sets the date. (BIOS automatically determines the day of the week.) Press ← or
→ to move to the desired field (date, month, year). Press PgUp or PgDn to
incrementally move the setting, or type the desired value into the field.
Time
Sets the clock in 24-hour format.
For example, 1 p.m. is 13:00:00. Press ← or → to move to the desired field. Press
PgUp or PgDn to incrementally move the setting, or type the desired value into
the field.
IDE Primary Master
IDE Primary Slave
IDE Secondary Master
IDE Secondary Slave
When selecting items marked with a “>”, such as the IDE device setting (IDE
Primary Master), the screen for selecting options is displayed and specifications
can be set.
IDE HDD AutoDetection
Push the Enter key to execute the auto detection for the device. If the
connection is made, information obtained from the device, including the
access method, will be applied.
IDE Primary Master
IDE Primary Slave
IDE Secondary Master
IDE Secondary Slave
Set the detection method for the connection device.
None: The connection detection is not executed. It is treated as disconnected
software
Auto:
Auto detection is executed. The information held by the device is
automatically applied.
Manual: The information set by the user is applied.
Access Mode
Set the access Method to the connected device. Note that when the device
detection method is set as “None” it cannot be changed.
CHS:
Access for the device is shortened with “Cylinder Head Sector
(Addressing) “having 0 to 1023 cylinders, 0 to 15 heads and 0 to 63
sectors.
LBA:
Shortened with the Logical Block Addressing Method, the entire
memory area is divided into access units and those serial numbers are
used for accessing.
Large: This is the access method for extended CHS. When the number of CHS
cylinders exceeds the normal amount of 1024 cylinders, the address is
not accessible so the CHS is extended.
Auto:
BIOS determines the optimum method based on the information
obtained by the device. The LBA method is normally used.
Capacity
This item indicates the memory capacity for the connection device. The
following differences occur, depending on the device detection method used.
Auto:
The value calculated according to information obtained by the device
is displayed.
Manual: The value calculated according to information specified by the user is
displayed.
Cylinder
This item indicates the number of cylinders for the connection device. The
following differences occur, depending on the device detection method used.
Auto:
The value obtained by the device is displayed.
Manual: The user can set the value within a range of 0-65,535 only when the
access method is set as “CHS”.
Head
This item indicates the number of heads for the connection device. The following
differences occur, depending on the device detection method used.
Auto:
The value obtained by the device is displayed.
Manual: The user can set the value within a range of 0-255 only when the access
method is set as “CHS”.
5-5 BIOS Functions
Table 5-2 Standard CMOS Features menu (continued)
Items
Description
Precomp
This item indicates the number of write compensation cylinders for the
connection device. The following differences will occur, depending on the
device detection method used.
Auto:
The value obtained by the device is displayed.
Manual: The user can set the value within a range of 0-65,535 only when the
access method is set as “CHS”. (When connecting a device for which
there is no particular value specified, a maximum value of 65,535 is
specified)
Landing Zone
This item indicates the head fixed track number for the connection device. The
following differences will occur, depending on the device detection method
used.
Auto:
The value obtained by the device is displayed.
Manual: The user can set the value within a range of 0-65,535 only when the
access method is set as “CHS”. (When connecting a device for which
there is no particular value specified, the number “1” is specified as the
maximum number of cylinders).
Sector
This item indicates the number of sectors for the connection device. The
following differences will occur, depending on the device detection method
used.
Auto:
The value obtained by the device is displayed.
Manual: The user can set the value within a range of 0-255 only when the access
method is set as “CHS”.
Drive A
Drive A type is set. The definition for each setting is as follows.
None: This setting is used when the FDD is disconnected or when the FDD is not
loaded. Please note that when this setting is used, system resources,
such as the IRQ cannot be opened. When you want to open the system
resources when using this setting, select “Disabled” under Integrated
Peripherals: Onboard FDC Controller, and “Yes” under Advanced BIOS
Features: Report No FDD For WIN 95. When using this setting or the
“Disabled” setting for the FDC, be sure to change to the Halt On setting.
360K, 5.25 in.:A 5.25 inch drive cannot be loaded on this device so 5.25 cannot
be selected as a setting.
1.2M, 5.25 in.:A 5.25 inch drive cannot be loaded on this device so 5.25 cannot
be selected as a setting.
720K, 3.5 in.:The fixes the floppy drive Read/Write to 720KB. Please note that
since a 720KB Read/Write floppy disk can also be used for a standard
equipped Read/Write floppy disk set at 3.5 inch and 1.44M, there is very
little value in using this setting.
1.44M, 3.5 in.:This is the normal setting. This is the desired setting for both the
default setting and the Fail-Safe/ Optimized.
2.88M, 3.5 in.:The standard FDD is not compatible with 2.88MB, so this setting
cannot be used.
Halt On
Sets the system stop conditions for startup (POST). The definitions for each of the
settings are as follows.
All Errors:Use this setting to stop the system when an error occurs.
No Errors:Use this setting to disregard the occurrence of errors and continue the
startup process.
All, But Keyboard:Use this setting to stop the system when any error occurs, with
the exception of keyboard-related errors. This is the default setting for
both Fail-Safe/ Optimized.
All, But Diskette:Use this setting to stop the system when any error occurs, with
the exception of floppy disk-related errors.
All, But Disk/Key:Use this setting to stop the system when any error occurs, with
the exception of floppy disk or keyboard-related errors.
5-6 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Advanced BIOS Features Menu
In this menu, set the basic BIOS settings, such as cache, boot-up sequence, and memory
shadowing.
Table 5-3 Advanced BIOS Features menu
Items
Description
Virus Warning
This is the setting for the data write enable/ disable to the boot sector and partition table. For
the default setting, Fail-Safe is “Enabled” and Optimized is “Disabled”.
Enabled:This is the setting used to disable the write function. Although this setting protects the
system from viruses, it does not permit execution of FDISK or FORMAT.
Disabled:This is the setting used to enable the write function. Although FDISK and FORMAT can
be executed using this setting, it does not protect the system from viruses. Always use
the default setting.
External Cache
This setting enables/disables the L2 Cache inside the CPU.
Enabled:Enables the L2 Cache. This is the normal setting.
Disabled:Disables the L2 Cache. This setting may have an adverse effect on the system
performance.
CPU L2 Cahce
ECC Checking
This is the setting that enables/disables the ECC check for the L2 Cache in the CPU. The default
setting is “Enabled”.
Enabled:This setting is used to perform the ECC check. This is the normal setting.
Disabled:This setting is used when the ECC check is not performed.
Quick Post
Sets POST processing conditions. The default setting Quiet Post is set as “Disabled”.
Enabled:This setting is used to perform the memory test when rebooting after resetting the
software or when auto detection of the IDE device is omitted. This makes it possible to
reduce the time required for rebooting via software reset.
Disabled:This setting is used to perform the memory test when rebooting after resetting the
software or when auto detection of the IDE device is not omitted.
Quick Power On
Self Test
Sets POST processing conditions. The default setting Quick Power On Self Test is set as
“Enabled”.
Enabled:This setting is used to execute the POST processing (memory self diagnostic test) only
once during startup. This setting can be used to reduce the time required for startup.
Disabled:This setting is used to execute the POST processing (memory self diagnostic test)
several times during startup.
The ESC key may be pressed during POST to skip the processing.
First Boot Device
This setting sets the search order for the startup device. The search is performed in the order of
First -> Second -> Third device and starts up from the first device that is capable of performing
the startup (one that has a boot sector and that can be loaded with IPL).
For both the default setting and Fail-Safe/Optimized, the settings are First =”Floppy”, Second
=”HDD-0” and Third = “SCSI”. Change the setting so that it is compatible with the system
configuration.
Second Boot
Device
Third Boot
Device
Boot Other
Device
Even if a device search is performed in the order of First/Second/Third Boot Devices, and a
device that is capable of performing the startup is not found, this setting can be used to
execute/not execute the Boot Other Device function. The default setting is set as “Enabled”.
Change the setting so that it is compatible with the system configuration.
Enabled:This setting is used to search for another device that is capable of performing the
startup.
Disabled:This setting is used to disable the search for another device that is capable of
performing the startup.
Reference: Information concerning the boot sequence
If bootable SCSI drives (e.g., HDD and CD-ROM) are connected, some products give priority to
such SCSI Drives regardless of the First Boot Device, Second Boot Device, Third Boot Device,
and Boot Other Device settings. This is due to the specifications of the SCSI BIOS (adapters) in
question.
Rev.C
5-7 BIOS Functions
Table 5-3 Advanced BIOS Features menu (continued)
Items
Description
Boot Up Floppy
Seek
This setting is used to enable/disable the head seek test (either execute or not execute the
head seek command) for floppy drive A during the startup. The default setting is “Enabled”.
Enabled:This setting is used to execute the head seek test. If the Standard CMOS Features: Drive
is set as “None” and the Integrated Peripherals: Onboard FDC Controller is changed to
“Disabled”, then if the Standard CMOS Features: Halt On is set as “All Errors” or the All,
But Keyboard setting is used, system errors will halt.
Disabled:This setting is used to disable the head seek test. Although this setting will reduce the
amount of time required to perform the head seek for the floppy during startup, it does
not perform an accurate error detection of FDD errors.
Boot Up Num
Lock Status
This setting turns the NumLock on the keyboard On or OFF (executes or does not execute the
NumLock command). The default setting is “OFF”.
Off:
This setting is used to turn the NumLock Off.
On:
This setting is used to turn the NumLock On.
Gate A20
Option
This setting is used to set the access method for a memory space of more than 1MB. The default
setting should be “Normal” for Fail-Safe and “Fast” for Optimized.
Normal: This setting is used only for access methods (real mode access) Pertaining to the
conventional AT transposing apparatus which use a keyboard controller.
Fast:
This setting is used for the Gate A20 function for the chip set. This is the original setting
used to perform automatic switching between the real mode and the protect mode.
Typematic Rate
Setting
This setting is used to enable/disable changes to the repeat conditions. The default setting is
“Disabled”.
Disabled:This setting is used when the apparatus is to be used at a fixed setting, without
changing the number of repetitions or the intervals between repetitions. For the fixed
setting, a repetition occurs once every 6 seconds with intervals of 250 msec. This is the
normal setting.
Enabled:This setting is used when the number of repetitions and the intervals between
repetitions is changed. For details, refer to Typematic Rate (Chars/Sec.) and
Typematic Delay (Msec).
Typematic Rate
(Chars/Sec)
This setting is used by to determine how many times an entry is made in a one-second period
when a key is held down. The fixed setting is 6 times per second. Additional settings are 8, 10, 12,
15, 20, 24 and 30.
Typematic
Delay
(Msec)
This setting is used to set the number of Msec for the intervals between data when a key is held
down. The fixed setting is 250 Msec. Additional settings are 500, 750 and 1000.
Security Option
Sets the password entry timing. The default setting is “Setup”. The password is set in Main Menu:
Set Supervisor Password and Main Menu: Set User Password.If a password is not set in these
items, this setting will have no significance.
The relationships between this setting and the password set are as follows:
“Setup” Setting
“System” Setting
When starting the OS:
--User Password or Supervisor Password
When changing BIOS Setup:
Supervisor Password
Supervisor Password
When only displaying BIOS Setup:
User Password
User Password
OS Select For
DRAM > 64MB
This setting is used to specify whether the OS/2 has more than 64MB of memory or not. The
default setting is “Non-OS2”.
Non-OS2:This setting is used when an OS other than an OS2 is used. This is the normal setting.
OS2:
This setting is used when the OS is an OS2. By using this setting, the method for
communicating the mounted memory capacity changes to a method specified by
the OS2.
5-8 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Table 5-3 Advanced BIOS Features menu (continued)
Rev.C
Items
Description
HDD S.M.A.R.T
capability
This setting is used to specify whether the S.M.A.R.T (Self-Monitoring, Analysis and Reporting
Technology) function is being used or not. If the connection device is not compatible with ATA3 (Ultra-ATA) standards or above, this means that the device does not support the S.M.A.R.T.
function, making this setting invalid. The default setting is "Enabled".
Enabled:"Enabled" is used to set the S.M.A.R.T. function. Please note that in order to use this
setting a command device is necessary to initiate this function during startup and a
separate software package is needed to activate the S.M.A.R.T. function. This is the
normal setting.
Disabled:This setting is used to disable the S.M.A.R.T function.
Report No FDD
For WIN 95
This setting is used to communicate to the Microsoft Windows OS whether an FDD is installed or
not (more exactly, the IRQ-6 status) The default setting is "No".
No:
"No" is the setting used when no communication is made to the OS. This is the normal
setting.
Yes:
This setting is used when an FDD is not installed or when the necessary software has not
been installed. More exactly, this setting is used to communicate to the OS that the
IRQ-6 used by the FDC has been opened. Please refer to the section on floppy disks
regarding the use of FDD.
Video BIOS
Shadow
This setting is used to specify whether shadowing is performed or not for each address space
when a PC card with an expanded ROM BIOS is attached to the slot. All default settings are set
to "Disabled".
Disabled:This setting is used when shadowing of the target address spaces is not performed.
More exactly, if no PC card is attached to the slot, then it means that the PC card
does not have an expanded ROM BIOS mounted on it.
Enabled:This setting is used when shadowing of the target address spaces is performed. More
exactly, it means that the PC card attached to the slot has an expanded ROM BIOS,
such as an SCIS network card, mounted on it.
5-9 BIOS Functions
Advanced Chipset Features Menu
In this menu, set the items that rely on the chipset on the main board, such as the memory and
the bus timing setting. Since these settings are executed via Load Optimized Defaults, they are
the optimum settings for the system and generally do not need to be changed. Be aware that
because these settings pertain to the control timing, the apparatus may fail to start up if an
incompatible setting is executed.
Table 5-4 Advanced Chipset Features menu
Items
Description
SDRAM CAS
Latency Time
This setting sets the number of clocks for the CAS waiting time for the memory (the time
required from when the address is specified until the data can be read out). Default setting is
“3”. Do not change the default setting.
System BIOS
Cacheable
This setting enables/disables the System BIOS cache. The default setting is "Disabled".
Disabled: Set this to disable the system BIOS cache.
Enabled: Set this to enable the system BIOS cache.
Video BIOS
Cacheable
This setting enables/disables the Video BIOS cache. The default setting is "Disabled".
Disabled: Set this to disable the system BIOS cache.
Enabled: Set this to enable the system BIOS cache.
CPU Latency
Timer
CPU and Chip set (GMCH: this setting pertains to the access timing for the Graphics Memory
Control Hub). The default setting is "Disabled". The normal setting is "Disabled".
Delayed
Transaction
Always set this to “Enabled“.
CAS# Latency
This setting sets the number of clocks for the video cache memory CAS waiting period (the
amount of time required after the address is specified until the data can be read out). There
are 2 options, a setting of "2" or "3". The default setting is "3". The normal setting is "3" to ensure a
more stable system.
Paging Mode
Control
This setting controls the page mode for the video cache memory. The options are "Open" and
"Close". The default setting is "Open". The normal setting is "Open" because it operates in the
page open mode.
RAS-to-CAS
Override
This setting determines how much time is required until performing the transfer to CAS following
the video cache memory RAS. The options are the "by CAS# LT setting and the "Override(2)"
setting. The default setting is the "by CAS# LT setting. Normally, the CAS# Latency setting is used
to automatically set the "by CAS# LT" setting.
RAS# Timing
This setting is used to set the RAS access timing for the video cache memory. The two options
are "Fast" and "Slow". The default setting is "Fast". Normally, the "Fast" setting is used to ensure
better performance.
RAS# Precharge
Timing
This setting sets the number of clocks to allocate to RAS in order to accumulate the necessary
charge before refresh of the video cache memory is performed. There are two options, "Fast"
and "Slow". The default setting is "Fast". Normally, the "Fast" setting is used to ensure better
performance.
5-10 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Integrated Peripherals Menu
This menu sets the items related to I/O ports such as the IDE controller, the transfer mode, the
serial ports, and the parallel port.
Table 5-7 Integrated Peripherals menu
Rev.C
Items
Description
On-chip Primay/
Secondary PCI
IDE
This setting is to enable/disable the IDE controller housed in the chip set (ICH2). All of the default
settings are set as "Enabled". Always use the default "Enabled" setting.
If the "Disabled" settings are used, the IRQ resources are released and become available for
other devices. If the IRQ resources that are released, IRQ-14 is released for the primary and IRQ15 for the secondary.
IDE Primary/
Secondary:
Master/Slave
PIO
This setting sets the transfer mode for the IDE device connected to each interface. All of the
default settings are "Auto". The PIO is normally set as "Auto," but due to the auto detection
performed during POST, the optimum method used by the connection device is then set as
BIOS.
If devices in different modes are connected to the master and the slave, the transfer mode will
be fixed at a slow speed; therefore, it is necessary to pay particular attention to the connection
to each port. If a setting is made that exceeds the maximum mode supported by the device
connected, note that data errors may occur. If On-Chip Primary/Secondary PCI IDE is set to
"Disabled," the corresponding items cannot be selected.
IDE Primary/
Secondary:
Master/Slave
UDMA
This setting sets the DMA transfer mode for the IDE device connected to each interface. All
default settings are set as "Auto". The UDMA is normally set as "Auto, but due to the auto
detection performed during the POST, the DMA mode support status for the connection device
is determined as BIOS.
If any of the devices connected does not support DMA mode, the maximum mode that
device supports will be set. If On-Chip Primary/Secondary PCI IDE is set to "Disabled," the
corresponding items cannot be changed.
When using the UDMA, set as “Auto“
The transfer mode for the DMA mode compatible device connected to the IDE interface in
each OS can be changed to the DMA mode using the following methods. For BIOS settings, set
IDE ... UDMA to "Auto." This has been supported for the OS for EPSON.
1. Windows NT
Using a tool in Service Pack 6a, Refer to “Chapter 3“
2. Windows 98
Setting the OS, Refer to “Chapter 3“
3. Windows 2000 By applying Chip Set Driver, the mode can be automatically changed to
the DMA mode.
4. Windows XP
The DMA mode is automatically set upon installing the Windows XP
operating system.
USB Controller
This setting is used to enable/disable the USB controller housed in the chip set (ICH2).
The default setting is set as "Enabled".
Perform setting according to your system configuration (whether or not a USB device is
connected). If the "Disabled" setting is used, USB Keyboard Support can be selected and this
function is not supported. The PnP BIOS automatically determines the IRQ resource settings for
the USB controller.
USB Keyboard
Support
This setting enables/disables the emulation functions for the USB keyboard. The default setting is
"Disabled".
AC97 Audio
This setting enables/disables the audio controller housed in the chip set (ICH2).
The default setting is "Auto". Perform setting (using or not using the audio controller) according
to your system configuration.
Auto:
Choose this if the audio controller built in the chip set (ICH2) is used.
Disabled: Choose this if the audio controller built in the chip set (ICH2) is not used.
The IRQ resources for the audio controller are allocated if the "Auto" setting is selected; they are
not allocated if the "Disabled" setting is selected.
5-11 BIOS Functions
Table 5-7 Integrated Peripherals menu (continued)
Items
Description
Onboard LAN
Device
This setting enables/disables the network controller housed in the chip set (ICH2).
The default setting is "Enabled".Perform setting (using or not using the network controller)
according to your system configuration.
Enabled: Choose this if the network controller built in the chip set (ICH2) is used.
Disabled: Choose this if the network controller built in the chip set (ICH2) is not used.
The IRQ resources for the network controller are allocated as follows:
Enabled: PnP BIOS automatically allocates IRQ resources.
Disabled: IRQ resources are not allocated.
IDE HDD Block
Mode
This setting enables/disables the IDE-HDD multi-sector transfer mode.
The default setting is "Enabled". Always use the default setting.
Enabled: Choose this to set the multi-sector transfer mode.If data is stored extending over
continuous sectors, performance will improve.
Disabled: This sets the single sector transfer mode.
Onboard Lan
Boot ROM
This setting enables/disables the PXE Boot Agent function.
When the Onboard LAN Device is "Disabled", the Onboard Lan Boot ROM setting does not
function. The default setting is "Enabled".
Enabled: Choose this if the PXE Boot Agent function is used.
Disabled: Choose this if the PXE Boot Agent function is not used.
When OS mistakes the PCI I/F Card, it is possible to avoid in setting "Disabled".
When "Disabled"setting, the PXE Boot Agent function cannot be used.
Onboard FDC
Controller
This setting enables/disables the floppy controller inside the S-I/O (W83627).
The default setting is "Enabled". Always use the default setting.
Enabled: Choose this if the FDD is used.
Disabled: Choose this if the FDD is not used.
Onboard Serial
Port 1/2/3/4
This setting enables/disables serial controller #1/2/3/4 (combination of the I/O address and IRQ
resource for serial port #1) inside the S-I/O (W83627).
The default setting are as follows.
Serial Port 1 : 3F8/IRQ4
Serial Port 2 : 2F8/IRQ3
Serial Port 3 : 3E8/IRQ11
Serial Port 4 : 2E8/IRQ10
There are options, the "3F8/IRQ4" setting, "2F8/IRQ3" setting, "3E8/IRQ4" setting, "2E8/IRQ3"
setting, "3F8/IRQ11" setting, "2F8/IRQ10" setting, "3E8/IRQ11" setting, "2E8/IRQ10" setting, "338/
IRQ11" setting, "238/IRQ10" setting, and "Disabled" setting.
Make the necessary changes in accordance with the system configuration.
Onboard Serial
Port 5/6, Serial
Port 5/6 Use IRQ
This setting enables/disables serial controller #5/6 (combination of the I/O address and IRQ
resource for serial port #1) inside the S-I/O (W83697UF).
The default setting is "Disabled".
There are options of [Onboard Serial Port 5/6], the "3F8" setting, "2F8"setting, "3E8"setting,
"3E8"setting, "338"setting, "238"setting and "Disabled" setting.
There are options of [Serial Port 5/6 Use IRQ], the "IRQ3" setting, "IRQ4" setting, "IRQ5" setting,
"IRQ7" setting, "IRQ10" setting, "IRQ11" setting, "IRQ14" setting and "IRQ15" setting.
Make the necessary changes in accordance with the system configuration.
Onboard
Parallel Port
5-12 BIOS Functions
This setting enables/disables the parallel controller (combination of the I/O address and IRQ
resource for the parallel port) inside the S-I/O (W83627F).
The default setting is "378/IRQ7".
There are 4 options, the "Disabled" setting, "378/IRQ7" setting, "278/IRQ5" setting and the "3BC/
IRQ7" setting.
When using the "Disabled" setting, system resources can be opened and the port can be used
with other devices.
Make the necessary changes in accordance with the system configuration.
Note that since an 8-byte continuous I/O space is needed when setting the parallel port mode
to "EPP", the 3BC/IRQ7 setting cannot be used.
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Table 5-7 Integrated Peripherals menu (continued)
Items
Description
Parallel Port
Mode
This setting sets the parallel port mode. The default setting is "Normal".
There are 4 options, "Normal", "EPP", "ECP" and "ECP+EPP". Make the necessary changes in
accordance with the system configuration.
Note that since an 8-byte continuous I/O space is needed when using the "EPP" setting and
"ECP+EPP" setting, the 3BC/IRQ7 setting cannot be used.
In addition, a DMA channel number is required for the DMA transfer when using the "ECP"
setting and "ECP+EPP" setting.
The definitions for each mode are listed below.
Normal: Also called the SPP (Standard Parallel Port), this mode is for one direction only.
EPP:
EPP stands for Enhanced Parallel Port and is an improvement for the Normal mode I/O
throughput. EPP allows for faster data transfer than Normal mode.
ECP:
ECP stands for Extended Capabilities Port, and it is a mode that supports DMA transfer
and Run Length Enhanced. ECP allows for faster data transfer.
EPP Mode
Select
EPP Mode Select sets the type of EPP mode. The default setting is "EPP1.7".
There are 2 options, the EPP1.7 setting and the "EPP1.9 " setting.
Make the necessary changes in accordance with the system configuration.
ECP Mode Use
DMA
Sets the DMA channel number for the "ECP" and "ECP+EPP" setting.
The default setting is "3". There are 2 options, "1" and "3".
Make the necessary changes in accordance with the system configuration.
Power Management Setup Menu
In this menu, set the items related to power management.
Table 5-5 Power Management Setup menu
Rev.C
Items
Description
Video Off
Method
Sets the method to turn the monitor off for the Video Off Mode.
The default setting is DPMS.
Change the setting to match the system configuration (type of connected monitor).
The settings are explained below.
Bland Screen:
Use this setting when connecting an earlier version monitor that is
compatible with power management terminals that only have a video off
function.
V/H SYNC+Blank: This stops output of the horizontal sync signal, vertical sync signal, and display
signal from the video controller. Use this setting for monitors in which power
management is enabled when these signals end.
DPMS:
This activates BIOS control in accordance with the Display Power
Management System (DPMS) function of the video controller. The monitor
must be equipped with the DPMS function.
Video Off In
Suspend
Use this setting to turn off the video when entering Suspend Mode.
The default setting is Yes. Always use the default setting.
Yes:
Choose this to stop video output in Suspend Mode.
No:
With this setting video output continues even in Suspend Mode.
Suspend Type
Set the Suspend method of S1(POS) mode.
The default is "PwrOn Suspend".
There are two options; ”PwrOn Suspend” and ”Stop Grant”.
MODEM Use IRQ
Use this setting on a system with a modem when access to the modem (IRQ resource trap) is
treated as a resume event from Suspend Mode or when the power is turned on by a ring signal
(when the Power On by Ring setting is set to Enabled). The default setting is NA.
This setting is the IRQ resource number allocated to the modem (serial port).
5-13 BIOS Functions
Table 5-5 Power Management Setup menu (continued)
Items
Description
Suspend Mode
Select the time it takes for the system to enter Suspend Mode by BIOS from option settings.
The default setting is Disabled.
Be careful not to set the time value too small as the system may frequently switch between FullOn Mode and Suspend Mode.
Setting for OS
Windows NT: Because entering the Suspend mode on Windows NT creates a delay in the timer
of the operating system, be sure that the suspend timer setting is functioning properly.
Windows 98/2000/XP: For Windows 98 and later operating systems, set the suspend timer from
the system. The BIOS suspend timer is ignored regardless of the setting.
HDD Power
Down
Select the item it takes for the HDD to enter the Power Down mode by BIOS from option setting.
The default setting is “Disabled”.
This function was added from Ver.2.11.02.
And the version of before Ver.2.11.01 does not have this function.
Soft-Off by PWRBTTN
Sets the function of the Power Button (switch) when pressed.
The default setting is Instant-Off. The basic operations of BIOS are as follows.
Instant-Off:
The power supply is turned off immediately when the Power button is
pressed.
Delay 4 Sec.:
If the Power button is pressed and held for less than 4 seconds:
1) Shift to the Suspend mode if this operation is performed in the Full-On
mode.
2) Shift to the Full-On mode if this operation is performed in the Suspend
mode.
If the Power button is pressed and held for at least 4 seconds:
1) Shift to the Suspend mode once, and the power supply is forcefully turned
off after 4 seconds.
Disabled:
1) Nothing happens when the Power button is pressed in the Full-On mode.
2) Recover to the Full-On mode when the Power button is pressed in the
Suspend mode.
3) If the Power button is pressed and held for at least 4 seconds, the power
supply is forcefully turned off.
If the power is forcibly turned off by continuously pressing the power button for at least four
seconds when "Delay 4 Sec." is set, the Wake On LAN (WOL) function cannot be used next time
the power is turned on. In this case, restart the system by using the power button and execute
normal power off by using the OS. The WOL function can then be used at next startup.
Wake-Up by PCI
card
Use this item to have the BIOS perform recovery from the Suspend mode to the Full-On mode
using the signal from the PC card mounted in the PCI slot, as well as to use the WOL function.
The default setting is "Disabled."
Enabled: Choose this to have the BIOS handle as a recovery event or to use the WOL
function.
Disabled: Choose this not to have the BIOS handle as a recovery event or not to use the WOL
function.
Power On by
Ring
Use this setting enable/disable turning the power on with the modem ring signal.
The default setting is Disabled.
Enabled: Choose this if the power is turned on using the ring signal.Also change the setting
for Modem Use IRQ.
Disabled: Choose this if the power is not turned on using the ring signal.
5-14 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Table 5-5 Power Management Setup menu (continued)
Items
Description
Resume by
Alarm
Use this setting to turn on the power with the alarm (date and time). Set Resume by Alarm to
the desired setting to enable or disable this function.
Enabled: Choose this to enable the alarm function.By selecting this, Date (of Month) Alarm
and Time (hh:mm:ss) Alarm can also be set.
Disabled: Choose this to disable the alarm function.This is the default setting.
Date(of Month)
Alarm
Time(hh:mm:ss)
Alarm
Use Date (of Month) Alarm to set the appropriate date.
Use Time (hh:mm:ss) Alarm to set the appropriate time.
Once the setting is made, the power turns on or the system resumes to Full-On Mode on the
selected day and time each month.
System Battery
Sets the system battery is equipped/not equipped.
The default is “Not Equipped”.
There are two options; “Not Equipped” and “Equipped”.
Reload Global
Timer Events
Sets the event to reload (reset) the BIOS power management timer.
This is treated as a resume event from Suspend Mode.
IDE primary master access (I/O trap) is generated.
Primary IDE 0:
Primary IDE 1:
IDE primary slave access (I/O trap) is generated.
Secondary IDE 0:
IDE secondary master access (I/O trap) is generated.
Secondary IDE 1:
IDE secondary slave access (I/O trap) is generated.
FDD, COM, LPT Port:
Access to the floppy disk drive, serial port, or the parallel port is
generated.
PCI PIRQ[A-D]#:
APCI interrupt request (I/O trap) is generated.
The default setting are as follows.
Primary IDE 0:
Enabled
Primary IDE 1:
Disabled
Secondary IDE 0:
Disabled
Secondary IDE 1:
Disabled
FDD, COM, LPT Port:
Enabled
PCI PIRQ[A-D]#:
Disabled
Supplementary Explanation for Power Management
Hard Disk Drive Power Down Mode
The HDD Power Down Timer settings are made through the OS in Windows XP/2000/98, but
in Windows NT/95 and DOS, the settings are made through the BIOS, as detailed below. To
have the HDD motor stop when the HDD is not accessed for a certain time, follow the steps
below:
1. Start up the BIOS Setup Utility.
2. Select [Power Management Setup].
3. Select [HDD Power Down].
4. Select the time in the option.
5. Save it and restart.
Rev.C
5-15 BIOS Functions
After the restart, when there is no HDD access for the time set, the HDD Power Down Timer
switches over to HDD Power Down and the motor of the HDD stops.
Note:
This function can be used only with BIOS version 2.13.00 or higher. If your BIOS version is before 2.12,
upgrade the BIOS and then do the above procedure.
When access to HDD occurs, the motor of HDD begins to start and the HDD becomes accessible.
Windows 98/2000/XP
Windows 98 and later operating systems have a hard disk drive power down function.
Therefore, this function can be used to control hard disk drive power down in these
operating systems.
5-16 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
PNP/PCI Configurations Menu
In this menu, set the IRQ and DMA assignment methods and other items. Do not change the
default settings under normal conditions.
Table 5-6 PNP/PCI Configurations menu
Rev.C
Items
Description
PNP OS Installed
Use this setting to select whether the operating system is compatible with Plug and Play (PnP).
The default setting is Yes. Always use the default setting.
Reset
Configuration
Data
Use this setting to reset the PnP information recorded in the Extended System Configuration
Data (ESCD) block when restarting the system.
The default setting is Disabled. Always use the default setting.
Resources
Contorlled By
Use this setting to select whether the allocation of the I/O address, IRQ, DMA, and other system
resources is to be done by PnP BIOS or by the user.
The default setting is Auto (ESCD). Always use the default setting.
IRQ Resources
Sets the handling of IRQ Resources (interrupt number).
You can change IRQ Resources 3, 4, 5, 7, 9, 10, 11, 12, 14, and 15.
The default setting is PCI/ISA PnP for each resource.
PCI/ISA PnP:
The target IRQ resources are allocated automatically (dynamic allocation)
by PnP BIOS, as is the case when the Resource Controlled By setting is set to
Auto (ESCD).
Legacy ISA:
The target IRQ resources are reserved (static allocation) and are not
affected by the PnP BIOS automatic (dynamic) allocation. When making
changes, be careful not to create a resource conflict.
DMA Resources
Sets the handling of DMA resources (DMA channels).
You can change DMA Resources 0, 1, 3, 5, 6, and 7.
The default setting is PCI/ISA PnP for each resource.
PCI/ISA PnP:
The target DMA resources are allocated automatically (dynamic allocation)
by PnP BIOS, as is the case when the Resource Controlled By setting is set to
Auto (ESCD).
Legacy ISA:
The target IRQ resources are reserved (static allocation) and are not
affected by the PnP BIOS automatic (dynamic) allocation. When making
changes, be careful not to create a resource conflict.
Memory
Resources
Use this setting to position the Upper Memory Block (UMB) in the expansion memory range.
The normal setting is default setting.
Reserved
Memory Base
Sets the position address. The default setting is "N/A", indicating that no position is selected. The
only position address that can be selected is "D000".
Reserved
Memory Length
If a position address is set, select the memory size for that address. The default setting is “64K”.
The only memory size that can be selected is “64K”, the same as the default setting.
PCI/VGA
Palette Snoop
When a video card is added or when using an MPEG playback card at the same time, the onscreen color may not display correctly for a period of time.
If this occurs, you may be able to fix the problem by changing the setting to Enabled.
The default setting is Disabled.
5-17 BIOS Functions
Defaults and Selectable Options
The BIOS default and selectable options of each item are as follows. Some items are not
displayed and cannot be changed, depending on the settings of their master items.
Standard CMOS Features
1) Date, Time
Item
Options
Notice
Day of the
week
—
Day of the week:
Month
Jan
Feb
Mar
Apr
May
Jun
Jul
Aug
Sep
Oct
Nov
Dec
Year, Month, Day:
Selected from the options.
Last day of the current month: Either 28, 30, or 31 is automatically
determined according to the specified
month. When the year is a leap year, the
last day of February will automatically
be 29.
Hour, Minute, Second:
Selected from the options.
Day
1- Last day of the
current month
Year
1999 - 2099
Hour
0 - 23
Minute
0 - 59
Second
0 - 59
5-18 BIOS Functions
Automatically determined by the settings of Year,
Month, and Day.
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
2) IDE Primary master, IDE primary slave, IDE secondary master, IDE secondary slave
Rev.C
Item
Options
Notice
IDE Primary Master /
Primary Slave /
Secondary Master /
Secondary Slave
None
Auto
Manual
Set the detection method for the connection device.
None: The connection detection is not executed. It is treated as
disconnected software
Auto:
Auto detection is executed. The information held by the
device is automatically applied.
Manual: The information set by the user is applied.
Access Mode
CHS
LBA
Large
Auto
Set the access Method to the connected device. Note that when the
device detection method is set as “None” it cannot be changed.
CHS:
Access for the device is shortened with “Cylinder Head Sector
(Addressing) “having 0 to 1023 cylinders, 0 to 15 heads and 0
to 63 sectors.
LBA:
Shortened with the Logical Block Addressing Method, the
entire memory area is divided into access units and those serial
numbers are used for accessing.
Large: This is the access method for extended CHS. When the number
of CHS cylinders exceeds the normal amount of 1024 cylinders,
the address is not accessible so the CHS is extended.
Auto:
BIOS determines the optimum method based on the
information obtained by the device. The LBA method is
normally used.
Capacity
-----
This item indicates the memory capacity for the connection device.
The following differences occur, depending on the device detection
method used.
Auto:
The value calculated according to information obtained by
the device is displayed.
Manual: The value calculated according to information specified by
the user is displayed.
Cylinder
-----
This item indicates the number of cylinders for the connection device.
The following differences occur, depending on the device detection
method used.
Auto:
The value obtained by the device is displayed.
Manual: The user can set the value within a range of 0-65,535 only when
the access method is set as “CHS”.
Head
-----
This item indicates the number of heads for the connection device. The
following differences occur, depending on the device detection
method used.
Auto:
The value obtained by the device is displayed.
Manual: The user can set the value within a range of 0-255 only when
the access method is set as “CHS”.
Prcomp
-----
This item indicates the number of write compensation cylinders for the
connection device. The following differences will occur, depending on
the device detection method used.
Auto:
The value obtained by the device is displayed.
Manual: The user can set the value within a range of 0-65,535 only when
the access method is set as “CHS”. (When connecting a
device for which there is no particular value specified, a
maximum value of 65,535 is specified)
5-19 BIOS Functions
Item
Options
Notice
Landing Zone
-----
This item indicates the head fixed track number for the connection
device. The following differences will occur, depending on the device
detection method used.
Auto:
The value obtained by the device is displayed.
Manual: The user can set the value within a range of 0-65,535 only when
the access method is set as “CHS”. (When connecting a
device for which there is no particular value specified, the
number “1” is specified as the maximum number of cylinders).
Sector
-----
This item indicates the number of sectors for the connection device.
The following differences will occur, depending on the device
detection method used.
Auto:
The value obtained by the device is displayed.
Manual: The user can set the value within a range of 0-255 only when
the access method is set as “CHS”.
3) FDD, Error Halt
The items related to the FDD and error that halt at boot-up are as follows.
Item
Options
Fail-Safe Default
Optimized Default
Drive A
None
360K , 5.25 in.
1.2M , 5.25 in.
720K , 3.5 in.
1.44M, 3.5 in.
2.88M, 3.5 in.
None
1.44M, 3.5 in.
Halt On
All Errors
No Errors
All,But Keyboard
All,But Diskette
All,But Disk/Key
All Errors
All Errors
Notes: When the Drive A is None setting, the system resources, such as the IRQ, cannot be released.
5-20 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Advanced BIOS Features
The basic items related to BIOS boot-up are as follows.
Rev.C
Item
Options
Fail-Safe Default
Optimized Default
Virus Warning
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Disabled
External Cache
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
CPU L2 Cache ECC
Checking
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
Quick Post
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Quick Power On Self Test
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
First Boot Device
Floppy
LS120
HDD-0
SCSI
CDROM
HDD-1
HDD-2
HDD-3
ZIP100
LAN
Disabled
Floppy
Floppy
Second Boot Device
Floppy
LS120
HDD-0
SCSI
CDROM
HDD-1
HDD-2
HDD-3
ZIP100
LAN
Disabled
HDD-0
HDD-0
Third Boot Device
Floppy
LS120
HDD-0
SCSI
CDROM
HDD-1
HDD-2
HDD-3
ZIP100
LAN
Disabled
SCSI
SCSI
Boot Other Device
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
Boot Up Floppy Seek
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
Boot Up NumLock Status
Off
On
Off
Off
5-21 BIOS Functions
Item
Options
Fail-Safe Default
Optimized Default
Gate A20 Option
Normal
Fast
Normal
Fast
Typematic Rate Setting *
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Typematic Rate (Chars/Sec)
*
6
8
10
12
15
20
24
30
6
6
Typematic Delay (Msec) *
250
500
750
1000
250
250
Security Option
Setup
System
Setup
Setup
OS Select For DRAM > 64MB
Non-OS2
OS2
Non-OS2
Non-OS2
HDD S.M.A.R.T Capability
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
Report No FDD For WIN 95
No
Yes
No
No
C8000-CBFFF Shadow
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
CC000-CFFFF Shadow
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
D0000-D3FFF Shadow
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
D4000-D7FFF Shadow
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
D8000-DBFFF Shadow
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
DC000-DFFFF Shadow
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
* When Typematic Rate Setting is a Disabled, Typematic Rate (Chars/Sec) and Typematic Delay
(Msec) cannot be selected.
5-22 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Advanced Chipset Features
The setup items related to the chipset are as follows.
Item
Options
Fail-Safe Default
Optimized Default
SDRAM CAS Latency Time
3
2
3
(Do not change)
3
(Do not change)
System BIOS Cacheable
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Video BIOS Cacheable
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
CPU Latency Timer
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Delayed Transaction
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
CAS# Latency
3
2
3
3
Paging Mode Control
Close
Open
Open
Open
RAS-to CAS Override
by CAS# LT
Override(2)
by CAS# LT
by CAS# LT
RAS# Timing
Slow
Fast
Fast
Fast
RAS# Precharge Timing
Slow
Fast
Fast
Fast
Integrated Peripherals
The setup items related to onboard peripherals are as follows.
Rev.C
Item
Options
Fail-Safe Default
Optimized Default
On-Chip Primary PCI IDE
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
On-Chip Secondary PCI
IDE
Disabled
Auto
Enabled
Enabled
IDE Primary Master PIO
Auto
Mode 0
Mode 1
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
Auto
Auto
IDE Primary Slave PIO
Auto
Mode 0
Mode 1
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
Auto
Auto
5-23 BIOS Functions
Item
Options
Fail-Safe Default
Optimized Default
IDE Secondary Master PIO
Auto
Mode 0
Mode 1
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
Auto
Auto
IDE Secondary Slave PIO
Auto
Mode 0
Mode 1
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
Auto
Auto
IDE Primary Master UDMA
Disabled
Auto
Auto
Auto
IDE Primary Slave UDMA
Disabled
Auto
Auto
Auto
IDE Secondary Master
UDMA
Disabled
Auto
Auto
Auto
IDE Secondary Slave
UDMA
Disabled
Auto
Auto
Auto
USB Controller
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
USB Keyboard Support
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
AC97 Audio
Auto
Disabled
Auto
Auto
Onboard LAN Device
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
5-24 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Rev.C
Item
Options
Fail-Safe Default
Optimized Default
IDE HDD Block Mode
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Enabled
Onboard Lan Boot ROM
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
Onboard FDC Controller
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
Onboard Serial Port 1
Disabled
3F8/IRQ4
2F8/IRQ3
3E8/IRQ4
2E8/IRQ3
3F8/IRQ11
2F8/IRQ10
3E8/IRQ11
2E8/IRQ10
338/IRQ11
238/IRQ10
3F8/IRQ4
3F8/IRQ4
Onboard Serial Port 2
Disabled
3F8/IRQ4
2F8/IRQ3
3E8/IRQ4
2E8/IRQ3
3F8/IRQ11
2F8/IRQ10
3E8/IRQ11
2E8/IRQ10
338/IRQ11
238/IRQ10
2F8/IRQ3
2F8/IRQ3
Onboard Serial Port 3
Disabled
3F8/IRQ4
2F8/IRQ3
3E8/IRQ4
2E8/IRQ3
3F8/IRQ11
2F8/IRQ10
3E8/IRQ11
2E8/IRQ10
338/IRQ11
238/IRQ10
3E8/IRQ11
3E8/IRQ11
Onboard Serial Port 4
Disabled
3F8/IRQ4
2F8/IRQ3
3E8/IRQ4
2E8/IRQ3
3F8/IRQ11
2F8/IRQ10
3E8/IRQ11
2E8/IRQ10
338/IRQ11
238/IRQ10
2E8/IRQ10
2E8/IRQ10
5-25 BIOS Functions
Item
Options
Fail-Safe Default
Optimized Default
Onboard Serial Port 5
Disabled
3F8
2F8
3E8
2E8
338
238
Disabled
Disabled
Serial Port 5 Use IRQ
IRQ3
IRQ4
IRQ5
IRQ7
IRQ10
IRQ11
IRQ14
IRQ15
IRQ7
IRQ7
Onboard Serial Port 6
Disabled
3F8H
2F8H
3E8H
2E8H
338H
238H
Disabled
Disabled
Serial Port 6 Use IRQ
IRQ3
IRQ4
IRQ5
IRQ7
IRQ10
IRQ11
IRQ14
IRQ15
IRQ5
IRQ5
Onboard Parallel Port
Disabled
378/IRQ7
278/IRQ5
3BC/IRQ7
378/IRQ7
378/IRQ7
Parallel Port Mode
Normal
EPP
ECP
ECP+EPP
Normal
Normal
EPP Mode Select
EPP1.9
EPP1.7
EPP1.9
EPP1.7
ECP Mode Use DMA
1
3
3
3
Notes: The Serial Port 5 Use IRQ can be selected if the Onboard Serial Port 5 is changed to I/O address
setting. The IRQ resource is not assigned in “Disabled” setting.
The Serial Port 6 Use IRQ can be selected if the Onboard Serial Port 6 is changed to I/O address
setting. The IRQ resource is not assigned in “Disabled” setting.
When Onboard Parallel Port is Disabled setting, Parallel Port Mode ,EPP Mode Select and ECP
Mode Use DMA are displayed, and the IRQ Resource is not assigned.
When the Parallel Port Mode for the EPP Mode Select is set as “EPP” or as “ECP+EPP”, the user can
then perform the necessary settings.
When the Parallel Port Mode for the ECP Mode Use DMA is set as “ECP” or as “ECP+EPP”, the user can
then perform the necessary settings.
5-26 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Power Management Setup
The setup items related to power management are as follows.
Rev.C
Item
Options
Fail-Safe Default
Optimized Default
Video Off Method
Blank Screen
V/H SYNC+Blank
DPMS
Blank Screen
DPMS
Video Off In Suspend
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Suspend Type
Stop Grant
PwrOn Suspend
PwrOn Suspend
PwrOn Suspend
MODEM Use IRQ
NA
3
4
5
7
10
11
14
15
3
NA
Suspend Mode
Disabled
1Min
2Min
4Min
8Min
12Min
20Min
30Min
40Min
1 Hour
Disabled
Disabled
HDD Power Down
Disabled
1 Min
2 Min
3 Min
4 Min
5 Min
6 Min
7 Min
8 Min
9 Min
10 Min
11 Min
12 Min
13 Min
14 Min
15 Min
Disabled
Disabled
5-27 BIOS Functions
Item
Options
Fail-Safe Default
Optimized Default
Soft-Off by PWR-BTTN
Instant-Off
Delay 4 Sec.
Disabled
Instant-Off
Instant-Off
Wake-Up by PCI card
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Power On by Ring
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Resume by Alarm
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Date (of Month) Alarm
-----
-----
-----
Time (hh:mm:ss) Alarm
-----
-----
-----
Primary IDE 0
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
Primary IDE 1
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Secondary IDE 0
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Secondary IDE 1
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
FDD, COM, LPT Port
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Enabled
PCI,PIRQ (A-D)#
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
5-28 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
PnP/PCI Configurations
The setup items related to PCI configurations (Plug and Play) are as follows.
Item
Options
Fail-Safe Default
Optimized Default
PNP OS Installed
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Reset Configuration Data
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Resource Controlled By
Auto(ESCD)
Manual
Auto(ESCD)
Auto(ESCD)
IRQ-3 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
IRQ-4 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
IRQ-5 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
IRQ-7 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
IRQ-9 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
IRQ-10 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
IRQ-11 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
IRQ-12 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
IRQ-14 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
IRQ-15 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
DMA-0 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
DMA-1 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
DMA-3 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
DMA-5 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
DMA-6 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
DMA-7 assigned to
PCI/ISA PnP
Legacy ISA
PCI/ISA PnP
PCI/ISA PnP
Notes: When Resources Controlled By is set to Manual, IRQ Resources, DMA Resources, and Memory
Resources can be set by the user.
Rev.C
5-29 BIOS Functions
Item
Options
Fail-Safe Default
Optimized Default
Reserved Memory Base
N/A
D000
N/A
N/A
Reserved Memory Length
64K
64K
64K
PCI/VGA Palette Snoop
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
Disabled
Notes: When Memory Resource is selected, Reserved Memory Base and Reserved Memory Size can be set from the
advanced settings screen.
For Reserved Memory Base, N/A and D000 can be selected from the option settings.
For Reserved Memory Size, 64K is the only option setting that can be selected.
5-30 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Setting a Password
Select the password setting option (Set Supervisor Password or Set User Password)
from the main menu, and the following message is displayed in the center of the screen. Type a
password. The password is case sensitive and made up of up to eight alphanumeric characters.
ENTER PASSWORD:
Typing a password clears any previously entered password. After you press Enter, the message
below is displayed.
CONFIRM PASSWORD:
Retype the password you typed. If you do not want to use any password, simply press Enter at
both prompts. The password will be cleared, and the password function will be disabled.
If you forget your password, short pins 2 and 3 of jumper JP5 for IR-320 and turn on the power
to clear the contents of the CMOS. After clearing the CMOS, be sure to perform the following:
❏ Remove the jumper cap from pins 2 and 3 of jumper JP5
❏ Execute LOAD Optimized Defaults (from the main menu of the BIOS setup utility)
❏ Reset BIOS (necessary items)
To abort the process, press Esc.
Rev.C
5-31 BIOS Functions
Power On Self-Test (POST)
The IR-320 inspects the system environment setting and the hardware by the Power On Self Test
( POST). When an error is detected, the error message is displayed, and beeps are produced.
Error messages are listed in following clause.
Beep sounds
The beep sounds when detecting the following errors.
❏ The memory errors are notified by repeating long beeps. Check the DIMM installation.
❏ The video errors are notified by repeating one long beep and two short beeps. The video
controller of the main board may be faulty.
❏ When detecting an error except the memory and the viceo, POST messages are displayed
with the short beep.
POST messages( Error detection )
The following is a list of POST messages. An error message may be followed by a prompt to
press F1 to continue or to press Del to enter setup.
Table 5-8 POST messages
Message
Description
BIOS ROM checksum error —
System halted.
The checksum of the BIOS code in the BIOS chip is incorrect, the possibility to
mistake by the BIOS code is shown.
CMOS battery failed.
The COMS battery is no longer functional. Replace the lithium battery of the
main board.
CMOS checksum error —
Defaults loaded.
The Checksum of the CMOS is incorrect, so the system loads the default
equipment configuration. A checksum error may indicate that the COMS is
corrupt. This error may be caused by a weak battery. Check the lithium
battery, and replace it if necessary.
DISK BOOT FAILURE, INSERT SYSTEM
DISK AND PRESS ENTER
When the disk that the system file is not installed in the FDD is inserted, pull out
it from the FDD and press Enter.
When the system file cannot be detected in "First Boot Device", "Second
Boot Device", "Third Boot Device" and "Boot Other Device", set the floppy disk
which a system disk is installed in, a CD-ROM or the other device, and then
press Enter.
Press Esc to skip memory test.
The user may press Esc to skip the full memory test.
Floppy disk(s) fail(**).
Cannot find or initialize the floppy drive controller or the floppy drive. Check
the FDD or the connection whether or not there is an error in the FDD setting
of the BIOS.
HARD DISK(S) FAIL (**).
Cannot find or initialize the hard drive controller or the hard drive. This
message is displayed when the sector verify error occurs while accessing the
hard disk.
PRESS F1 TO DISABLE NMI, F2 TO
REBOOT
A Non-Maskable Interrupt (NMI) occurs during POST. Press F1 to clear the MNI
and then continue with POST, and press F2 to reboot.
5-32 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
POST processing message
The BIOS displays the message of the POST processing while POST ( Power On Self Test ). These
messages are displayed until the operation system is booted. When the following message is
displayed, input according to the message. So another processing is done.
Table 5-9 POST processing messages
Rev.C
Message
Description
Press DEL to enter SETUP, ESC to
skip memory test
Press DEL to enter SETUP
This message is displayed in the lower left of the screen. Press ESC to omit the
full memory test. Press DEL to start POST again.
Press F10 to run device diagnostics
program
Press F10 to boot the device diagnostics utility.
(Reference)
EPSON IM-320 BIOS Ver X.YY.ZZ
The version of the BIOS is displayed.
5-33 BIOS Functions
5-34 BIOS Functions
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Chapter 6
Device Diagnostics Utility
The communication line between the devices connected to the IR-320 can be tested with the
device self-diagnostic utility.
With the device self-diagnostic utility, the following tests can be performed.
❏ Connection condition of each device
❏ Printing test for the TM printer
❏ Display test for the customer display
❏ Operational test for the cash drawer
❏ Loop-back test for the serial ports
❏ Loop-back test for the LPT1 port
❏ Printing test for the printer connected to LPT1
Conditions for Running Device Diagnostics
If the following conditions are not satisfied, self-diagnosis for each device cannot be performed.
Table 6-1 Conditions
Setting
Condition
Connection to the TM printer
The TM printer needs to be connected to the IR-320 body. Even if you will not
test the TM printer, connect the TM printer to either the COM port or LPT1.
Setting of the TM printer DIP
switches
Set the receive buffer to the maximum. Set the selection switch (connection/
non-connection of the customer display) to non-connection (if there is a
selection switch). If the TM printer does not have an ID function (ESC/POS GS I
command), set the communication settings following the instructions below.
Baud rate:
9600 bps
Word length:
8 bits
Parity:
None
See the instruction manual for the TM printer for the setup procedure.
Customer display connect port
When testing the customer display, connect the customer display to the
customer display port.
Rev. C
Device Diagnostics Utility 6-1
Confidential
Table 6-1 Conditions (continued)
Setting
Condition
Setting of DIP switches for the
customer display
When the TM printer is connected to COM1:
Set the communication settings following the instructions below, when the TM
printer has the ID function (ESC/POS GS I command).
Baud rate:
Same settings as for the TM printer (9600 bps)
Word length:
Same settings as for the TM printer (8 bits)
Parity:
Same settings as for the TM printer (None)
Set the communication settings following the instructions below, when the TM
printer does not have the ID function (ESC/POS GS I command).
Baud rate:
9600 bps
Word length:
8 bits
Parity:
None
When the TM printer is connected to another port besides COM1:
Set the communication settings of the customer display following the
instructions below.
Baud rate:
9600 bps
Word length:
8 bits
Parity:
None
For the setup procedure, see the instruction manual for the TM display.
Connection of the cash drawer
To check the kick-back motion of the drawer, connect the cash drawer.
Connection of the loop-back
connector
To execute the loop-back test for the serial ports and LPT1, connect the
loop-back connector to the port to be tested.
Setting of the serial ports and LPT
port
When the settings of the serial ports and LPT1 port have been changed,
return to the initial settings using the BIOS setup utility.
LPT
loop-back connector
1 -STROBE
2 D0
3 D1
4 D2
5 D3
6 D4
7 D5
8 D6
9 D7
10 -ACK
11 BUSY
12 PE
13 SLCT
14 -AFD
15 -ERR
16 -INIT
17 -SLCTIN
18 GND
19 GND
20 GND
21 GND
22 GND
23 GND
24 GND
25 GND
6-2 Device Diagnostics Utility
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Startup/Exit/Initialize
Startup
Press F10 during the POST process, and the message Diagnostics program will execute
after POST will appear, and the device self-diagnostic utility will start after the POST process.
Exit
When you select Exit from the menu, the device diagnostics utility is closed, and the IR-320 is
reset.
Initialize
When you select Initialize from the menu bar, the device self-diagnostic utility is initialized.
If the TM status message column in the TM/Drawer area or the DM status message column in
the DM area shows No communication, remove the cause, and select Initialize to initialize
the program.
Screen Layout
When the device diagnostic utility starts, the following screen appears.
The device self-diagnostic utility screen is divided into the following five areas.
❏ TM/Drawer
❏ DM
❏ COM Ports
Rev. C
Device Diagnostics Utility 6-3
Confidential
❏ LPT1
❏ Messages
TM/Drawer
The TM/Drawer area of the device diagnostics screen displays communication settings, cash
drawer driving pulse signal width, and the status for the TM printer and cash drawer.
Table 6-2 TM/DM information
Setting
Description
TM model
Displays the model name, depending on the type of TM printer attached.
TM port
Displays the TM printer connection you selected when you started device diagnostics.
TM reset signal
Indicates the signal and signal definition this product is using to reset the TM printer. You see
None here, because this printer does not have a reset signal.
Baud rate
Indicates the baud rate that device diagnostics is using to communicate with the TM printer
and DM display.
Word length
Indicates the word length that device diagnostics is using to communicate with the TM printer.
Parity
Indicates whether device diagnostics is using parity to communicate with the TM printer.
Drawer ON time
Displays the pulse width of the signal for opening the cash drawer.
TM status
Indicates the status of the TM printer. (See Table A-11.)
Drawer status
Displays the status of the cash drawer.
6-4 Device Diagnostics Utility
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Table 6-3 TM status messages
Message
Priority
Description
Disable
—
The port connected to the TM printer is disabled. Set to Enabled using BIOS setup.
No communications
—
This message is displayed when a TM printer that does not have the ID function
(ESC/POS GS I command) is connected. Check that the TM printer’s DIP switches
are set to the following.
Baud rate:
9600 bps
Word length:
8 bits
Parity:
None
If DIP switches are set correctly, the device self-diagnostic utility can communicate
with the TM printer even though the message is displayed. If any abnormality is
detected, examine the check items specified in this column.
When a TM printer that has the ID function (ESC/POS GS I command) is connected,
the device self-diagnostic utility cannot communicate with the TM printer for some
reason.
Check the following items.
❑ Are the interface cable and power cable connected to the TM printer
correctly? Before connecting the cables, be sure to power off the IR-320.
❑ Is the printer's power switch on?
❑ Is the TM printer connected to the port selected at startup of the device
self-diagnostic utility?
❑ Is the self-test for the TM printer not executed at start-up of the device
self-diagnostic utility? (Do not execute the self-test.)
❑ Is the paper FEED switch not pressed at start-up of the device self-diagnostic
utility? (Do not press the paper FEED switch.)
If the TM printer does not meet these conditions, correct the problem, and then
select the Initialize option from the menu bar.
If all the above conditions are satisfied, probable causes are the following.
❑ The print head has overheated.
❑ The TM printer is not working.
❑ he TM printer interface circuit of the IR-320 does not operate normally.
Hardware error
1
The print head is overheated, or the printer is not working.
Paper feeding
2
The TM printer is feeding paper.
Receipt end
3
The receipt paper path contains no paper.
Journal end
4
The journal paper path contains no paper.
Paper near-end
5
The paper roll is out of paper or is not installed.
Receipt near-end
6
The receipt paper roll is out of paper or is not installed.
Journal near-end
7
The journal paper roll is out of paper or is not installed.
Cover open
8
The printer cover is open.
On-line
9
The printer is online. It is possible to do a TM print test.
If the device self-diagnostic utility detects more than one TM status, it will display the highest-priority message. (If,
for example, TM statuses of priority 1 and 3 are detected, the message of priority 1 will be displayed.)
Rev. C
Device Diagnostics Utility 6-5
Confidential
DM
The DM area on the screen indicates the communication settings and status of the DM display.
Table 6-4 DM Information
Setting
Description
DM port
Indicates the port the device diagnostics utility is using to transmit data.
Baud rate
Indicates the baud rate that the device self-diagnostic utility is using to communicate
with the customer display.
Word length
Indicates the word length that the device self-diagnostic utility is using to communicate
with the customer display.
Parity
Indicates whether the device self-diagnostic utility is using parity to communicate with
the customer display.
DM status
Indicates DM status. See the table below.
Table 6-5 DM status messages
Message
Description
Disable
COM port A is not set at 3F8h. Set COM port A to 3F8h in setup.
No communication
The device self-diagnostic utility cannot communicate with the customer display. Check
the following items.
❑ Is the customer display connected? Before connecting the cable, be sure to power off
the IR-320.
❑ Are the data communication DIP switches the same for the customer display and the TM
printer?
❑ Is the power switch of the customer display turned on?
❑ Is the customer display executing the self-test? (Do not execute the self-test.)
If the customer display does not meet these conditions, correct the problem, and select the
Initialize option from the menu bar. If all the above conditions are satisfied, probable
causes are the following.
❑ The customer display interface circuit of the IR-320 does not operate normally.
❑ The customer display does not operate normally.
Busy
The customer display is busy. Probable causes are the following.
The customer display is executing the self-test.
After startup of the device self-diagnostic utility, the customer display has been powered
off.
Ready
The DM display is ready to receive data. The DM display test is possible.
COM port information
The area of the screen for COM ports lists the DTR, DSR, RTS, CTS, DCD, and RI status for each
available COM port. When the port is disabled, a message to that effect is shown.
LPT port information
The LPT1 area of the screen lists the BSY, ACK, PE, SLCT, and ERR status for the LPT1 port.
When the port is disabled, a message to that effect is shown.
6-6 Device Diagnostics Utility
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Messages
The message portion of the screen displays the result of tests.
Table 6-6 Message area
Test category
Message
Description
TM printer
Disabled
This port is disabled.
Done
The TM printer test is completed. Check the printing motion and autocutter motion.
Disabled
This port is disabled.
Done
The DM display test is completed. Check display.
Disabled
This port is disabled.
Done
The drawer kick-out test is completed. Check the motion of cash drawer.
Error
The diagnostics test failed. This message also appears when a loop-back connector
is not connected or the wrong loop-back connector is connected.
Disabled
This port is disabled.
OK
The test completed successfully.
Time out
The printer connected to the LPT1 port did not enter a ready state after 2 sec.
Disabled
This port is disabled.
OK
The print data was sent successfully.
DM display
Drawer kick-out
Loop-back
LPT1 print
Use for the device diagnostic utility
Operating Procedure
When the device diagnostic utility starts, the following screen appears.
Rev. C
Device Diagnostics Utility 6-7
Confidential
With the arrow keys (←, →), select the port connected to the TM printer for testing, and press
Enter. The device self-diagnostic utility examines items such as the TM and the DM for
connection and displays the status of the devices on the screen.
The device self-diagnostic utility is capable of displaying the connection status of the options
and executing the operation test. Follow these guidelines for using device diagnostics:
❏ To display a pull-down menu, use the left or right arrow key (←, →) to highlight the option;
then press Enter (if necessary). You also can see the pull-down menu if you press the key for
the first letter of the option. (The initialize option does not have a pull-down menu.)
❏ To select an option from the pull-down menu, use the up arrow or down arrow key to
highlight the option; then press Enter. If the option has a dialog box, you see it when you
press Enter.
❏ Press Esc to close a pull-down menu or a dialog box.
❏ Press Backspace to correct typing.
Setup Menu
The following two commands can be executed from the setup menu.
❏ Drawer Password
The password for accessing the drawer kick-out test can be set.
❏ Drawer ON Time
Sets the length of time for the voltage signal supplied to the cash drawer solenoid to open it.
❏ M/B Information
The device property, version of the MAC address, and keyboard firmware are confirmed.
6-8 Device Diagnostics Utility
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Setting a password for the drawer kick-out test
Follow the procedures below to set a password for the drawer kick-out test.
1. Select Drawer Password from the pull-down menu. Enter the password.
2. Type a password, and press Enter. The password should be four to eight alphanumeric
characters. It is case sensitive. Enter at least four alphanumeric characters.
3. The Re-enter message appears. Enter the password again, and press Enter. Then the
password will be saved.
If a password is set, you will be asked to enter the password each time the drawer kick-out test is
executed.
Changing/deleting the password for the drawer kick-out test
Follow the procedures below to change or delete the password for the drawer kick-out test.
1. Select Drawer Password from the pull-down menu. Enter the password.
2. Type the current password, and press Enter.
3. The message New appears.
4. To delete the password, only press Enter, and the password will be deleted. To set a new
password, type the new password, and press Enter.
5. The message Re-enter appears. Type the password again, and press Enter to confirm the
new password.
Rev. C
Device Diagnostics Utility 6-9
Confidential
Setting drawer ON time
The drawer ON time option sets the length of time of the voltage signal necessary to open the
cash drawer.
To set the time, select the Drawer ON Time option from the setup pull-down menu. The dialog
box is displayed. Specify the length of time of the voltage signal in units of milliseconds that the
cash drawer requires. Any value within a range of 0 to 500 ms can be set. The time that has been
set here is rounded to the minimum units that can be set for the TM printer connected. The
minimum unit is 10 ms for the TM-930 series and 2 ms for the other TMs.
For the appropriate value to be entered, see the instruction manual for the cash drawer.
6-10 Device Diagnostics Utility
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
M/B Information
The device property, configuration of the CPU and Memory, setting of the Video, Sound and
Ethernet, version of the MAC address, and keyboard firmware are confirmed.
Select M/B Information from the setup pull-down menu and the dialog box appears.
The information relative the mainboard can be confirmed.
•
Type of the CPU and the clock speed.
•
The memory capacity.
•
The setup property of video Enable/Disable.
•
The setup property of sound Enable/Disable.
•
The setup property of Ethernet and ROM Enable/Disable. The information for Ethernet
Identification.
•
The BIOS version information.
•
The Keyboard Firmware version information.
Device Test Menu
Each device can be tested from the Device Test menu. Executable device tests are as follows.
❏ TM print test
The following tests are executed in the TM print test.
Rev. C
Device Diagnostics Utility 6-11
Confidential
•
Print test on receipt paper (standard print pattern)
•
Autocutter test (for the autocutter equipped printer only)
When the test is completed, the message TM print test: done is displayed in the
message area. Make sure that the print pattern has been printed. For the autocutter
equipped printer, make sure that the receipt paper has been cut by the autocutter.
If the TM status is Disable or No communication, this test is not executed.
❏ DM display test
Sends the following messages to the DM display.
Display Module Test
**** Device Diagnostics ****
Check the screen of the customer display to make sure that the test has been executed.
When any key is pressed, the test will terminate, and the message DM display test:
done is displayed in the message area.
If the DM status is Disable or No communication, this test is not executed.
❏ Drawer kick-out test
The drawer kick-out test opens the cash drawer. Check to see if the cash drawer opens
normally. The TM printer has two drawer kick-out drive signals (signal 1 and signal 2). This
test checks the drawer kick-out drive signal 1 only.
If a password is set for the drawer kick-out test, enter the password when the drawer
kick-out test is executed.
If the TM status is Disable or No communication, this test is not executed.
❏ COM1/COM2/COM5/COM6 loop-back
The transmission/reception test for the serial port is executed. Because transmission and
reception are performed through a single target port, the loop-back connector needs to be
connected to the target port. The COM port test checks DTR, DSR, CTS, RTS, TXD, and RXD
signals.
When the test finishes normally, OK is displayed in the message area of the screen. When the
test fails, an error message is displayed.
❏ LPT1 loop-back
The LPT1 signal lines are tested. Because transmission and reception are performed through
a single target port, the loop-back connector needs to be connected to the target port. The
LPT1 port test checks STROBE, ACK, DATA0, BUSY, AUTO FEED, PAPER EMPTY, ERR,
INIT, SELECT IN, and SELECT signals. In the loop-back test, the data line test is not
executed. Data line check must be made through the LPT1 print test.
When the test finishes normally, OK is displayed in the message area of the screen. When the
test fails, an error message is displayed.
6-12 Device Diagnostics Utility
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
❏ LPT1 print test
The LPT1 print test prints the standard print pattern onto the printer connected to the LPT1
port.
When the test finishes normally, OK is displayed in the message area of the screen. When the
test fails, an error message is displayed.
NOTE
Set the BIOS of the COM/LPT port in default.
For the COM5/6 test, set the COM1/2 to Disable and set the COM5/6 to the follows.
COM5
COM6
Rev. C
F3F8
F2F8
IRQ4
IRQ3
Device Diagnostics Utility 6-13
Confidential
6-14 Device Diagnostics Utility
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Chapter 7
Hardware Specifications
System Diagram
The IR-320 consists of three boards. The device and the interface connected to each board are as
follows.
Main Power Switch
Front Power Switch
Rev. C
Hardware Specifications 7-1
System Memory
A 512 KB flash ROM is mounted on the IR-320 as the system ROM. After the BIOS is booted, the
system BIOS resides in the 64 KB area between 0F0000h and 0FFFFFh, and the video BIOS
resides in the 44 KB area (40 KB for the IR-300) between 0C0000h and 0CBFFFh. The area
between 0A0000h and 0FFFFFh in the system memory (main DRAM) is used for the shadow
memory and system management memory (SMM). The figure below is a system memory map.
RAM
expanded memory area
100000h
system BIOS
system ROM area
0F0000h
0E0000h
0CB000h
0C0000h
0B8000h
0B0000h
0A0000h
video BIOS
expanded ROM area
color
monochrome
graphics
video buffer area
RAM
conventional memory area
000000h
7-2 Hardware Specifications
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
I/O Map
The system I/O map is PC/AT-compatible, and the I/O address is allocated as listed in the table
below. Use either the BIOS setup program or Plug & Play function to change the serial and
parallel port addresses.
I/O map
I/O address
Description
Changeable?
Device
00h to 1Fh
DMA controller (8237A)
NO
82801BA
20h to 3Fh
Interrupt controller 1 (8259A)
NO
82801BA
40h to 5Fh
Timer / counter (8254)
NO
82801BA
60h to 6Fh
Keyboard controller (8042)
NO
W83627F
70h to 7Fh
Real-time clock, NMI mask
NO
82801BA
90h to 9Fh
DMA page register
NO
82801BA
A0h to BFh
Interrupt controller 2 (8259A)
NO
82801BA
B2h to B3h
Advanced Power Management control
NO
82801BA
C0h to DFh
DMA controller 2 (8237A)
NO
82801BA
F0h
Coprocessor error
NO
82801BA
170h to 177h
Hard disk controller (secondary)
NO
82801BA
1F0h to 1F7h
Hard disk controller (primary)
NO
82801BA
220h to 22Fh /
240h to 24Fh
Sound Blaster
YES
82801BA
2E8h to 2Efh
Serial port 4
YES
W83627F
2F8h to 2FFh
Serial port 2
YES
W83627F
376h
Hard disk controller (secondary)
NO
82801BA
378h to 37Fh
Parallel port 1
(+400h can be used when in the ECP mode)
YES
W83627F
388h to 38Bh
FM synthesizer (when a sound board is mounted)
NO
82801BA
3B0h to 3DFh
VGA register
NO
82810E2
3E8h to 3EFh
Serial port 3
YES
W83627F
3F0h to 3F7h
Floppy disk controller (excluding 3F6h)
NO
W83627F
3F6h
Hard disk controller (primary)
NO
82801BA
3F8h to 3FFh
Serial port 1
YES
W83627F
4D0h to 4D1h
Interruption edge / level control
NO
82801BA
CF8h to CFFh
PCI configuration register (DWORD)
NO
82810E2
CF9h
Reset control (byte)
NO
82801BA
4000-4037h
Power Management I/O Register
NO
82801BA
5000-5000Ch
SMBUS I/O register
NO
82801BA
Rev. C
Hardware Specifications 7-3
DMA
The IR-320 connects two 8237A-equivalent DMA controllers to support seven DMA channels.
Channels 0, 1, 2, and 3 provide 8-bit data transfers; channels 5, 6, and 7 provide 16-bit data
transfers. The IR-320 uses channel 2 for the floppy disk drive controller and releases the other
channels to the ISA bus. The following table lists the DMA channel allocation.
DMA channels
Controller
Channel
Application
DMA1 8 bits
0
(Spare)
1
(Spare*)
2
Floppy disk drive controller
3
(Spare*)
4
Controller 1 cascade
5
(Spare)
6
(Spare)
7
(Spare)
DMA2 16 bits
* When LPT1 is in ECP mode, use one of these channels.
System Interrupts
The system connects 2 8259A-equivalent interrupt controllers in cascade and has 15 levels of
interrupts, besides NMIs. The following table shows the application for each interrupt. Change
the system interrupts with the BIOS setup program or Plug & Play function.
System interrupts
Controller 1
Application
Changeable?
IRQ0
Controller 2
Timer
NO
IRQ1
Keyboard
NO
IRQ2
Controller 2 cascade
NO
IRQ8
RTC
NO
IRQ9
ACPI
NO
IRQ10
Serial port 4
OK
IRQ11
Serial port 3
OK
IRQ12
Mouse
OK
IRQ13
Numerical operation coprocessor
NO
IRQ14
Hard disk controller (primary)
*2
IRQ15
Hard disk controller (secondary)
*2
IRQ3
Serial port 2
OK
IRQ4
Serial port 1
OK
IRQ5
1
Not used *
OK
IRQ6
Floppy disk controller
NO *3
IRQ7
Parallel port 1
OK
NMI
I/O error check
NO
*1 PCI (for example, network) is automatically set through the detection of the unused interrupt level.
*2 Changes are not possible when the device is in use, but can be cleared when not in use.
*3 This can be set to “Not used” in the BIOS setup, but the IRQ is not released.
7-4 Hardware Specifications
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Hardware Specifications
CPU (Celeron-PPGA)
An Intel Celeron™ processor is used as the CPU.
CPU
Frequency
Package
L2 cache
System Bus
1.2GHz
FCPGA2
256KB
100MHz
733MHz
FCPGA
128KB
66MHz
Memory (168-pin DIMM)
Two 168-pin DIMM sockets are available, and a maximum of 512 MB of memory can be
mounted. The DRAM supports only the 3.3 V SDRAM (synchronous DRAM.) A single DIMM
can be used. It also is possible to use DIMMs of two differing capacities. DIMMs must conform
to the Intel PC SDRAM unbuffered DIMM specifications.
SDRAM specifications Conform to the Intel PC SDRAM Specifications Applicable to PC100
The DIMM of the PC133 can be used but it works at 100MHz.
Video Controller
The video controller in the chipset (Intel 810E2)
The video memory uses the part of the main memory, and the color count settings shown below
are possible for each resolution.
Display devices and colors that can be set
Display device
Resolution (dots)
DM-LR104T
DM-LR121SV/121SL
CRT
640 × 480
—
—
16,770,000 colors
800 × 600
16,770,000 colors
16,770,000 colors
16,770,000 colors
1024 × 768
—
—
65,000 colors
Notes: 1. The table above shows the number of colors that can be set. The number of colors that can be actually
displayed is limited to the number of display colors for each LCD unit.
2. 16,770,000 colors = 16 M colors = 24-bit; 65,000 colors = 64 K colors = 16-bit.
Note:
The number of colors that the TFT-type LCD unit can actually display for expression is 256.
IDE Devices
It is possible to mount up to two 2.5-in. HDDs as primary IDE devices and a CD-ROM drive ,
CD-R/RW drive and a CompactFlash disk as secondary IDE devices.
Note:
HDD Life: 5 years or when the total amount of use exceeds 20,000 hours. (Condition: The HDD’s motor
stops for 10 minutes or more every 24 hours(for 2.5” HDD)).
Rev. C
Hardware Specifications 7-5
Serial Device
The IR-320 has four serial ports (COM1, COM2, COM5, COM6 ). Also, +5V or +12V can be
output at the 1st pin by the Jumper setting of the main board. The serial ports COM3 and COM4
are internally used for the dedicated TM printer unit/customer display (COM3) and the touch
panel (COM4). Also, the system can be started up by the ring signal from the 9st pin.
To use the serial ports COM5 and COM6, it is necessary to set other unused devices (for
example, parallel ) to disabled (not used) using the BIOS setup and then allocate interrupts for
the serial ports COM5 and COM6.
PCI Slots
The PCI of the IR-320 has the following features:
❏
+3.3 V power supply
❏ Mountable PCI card size
The PCI cards within the dimensional range as shown in the following figure can be mounted.
135{5.3"} or less
135 mm
Parts Side
101 mm {4.0"}
or less
101
Three-terminal regulators for the drawer
As with the IR-320, the drawer can be used via the dedicated TM printer unit only when the
dedicated TM printer unit is connected. A three-terminal regulator for regulating the electric
current is mounted on the riser board.
Ethernet Controller
The Ethernet controller is built in the Chipset (Intel 82801BA). This enables operation at 10 Mbps
and 100 Mbps and wakeup from the LAN.
When the main power switch is on (when AC power is supplied), wakeup from the power off
state is enabled. To enable the wakeup, Wake-Up by PCI card should be set enabled in the
BIOS setup.
The operating status of LAN can be confirmed by the LED of the Ethernet connector.
7-6 Hardware Specifications
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
The MAC address specific to each controller is described on the seal attached to the main board
(remove the side panel which is on the left side of the unit). For Windows NT/2000/XP, the
MAC address can be obtained by using the following command:
ipconfig/all
CAUTION:
If connection is made directly from an outdoor, overhead LAN cable, the connected
equipment may be damaged by lightning. When connecting to such a cable, the
connection should be routed through a device to counter the surge; otherwise, do not
use the connection.
Power Supply Unit
Input Specification
Input voltage:
100 to 240 V AC (± 10%)
Frequency (rating):
50/60 Hz (± 3 Hz)
Input current:
6.0 A (100 V) to 4.0 A (240 V)
(except the power for AC outlet).
Outlet current
3A(rating)
The output of the AC outlet is interlocking with the power
on/off control in the system.
Protection Circuit/Unit
When the protection circuit is activated, it automatically shuts off the power. If recovery is
possible, turn off the main power switch, wait for more than 2 minutes, and then turn on the
main power switch.
❏ Short-circuit protection:
Shuts down the system when the output terminal (output power supply) is short-circuited.
Recovery is possible.
❏ Over-voltage protection:
Protection circuit to prevent the output terminals from exceeding the rated voltage.
Recovery is possible.
❏ Overheating protection:
Shuts down the system when excessive heat is detected in some element within the power
supply unit. Recovery is possible.
❏ Input power fuse:
Shuts down the system when the input current exceeds the specified value. Trouble within
the power supply unit is possible. If the fuse has blown, the whole power supply unit should
be replaced. Recovery is impossible.
Rev. C
Hardware Specifications 7-7
❏ AC output Fuse
If the fuse has blown, remove and exchange the fuse in the fuse holder on the back of the
power supply.
❏ Electrical Capacity to External Devices
The total power capacities available to the devices that receive power supply from the board
inserted into the PCI slot; the serial ports COM1, COM2, COM5, and COM6; the keyboard/
mouse; and the USB port are shown below. Be sure the current consumptions do not exceed the
total power capacities listed below as to the voltages 5 V, +3.3 V, +12 V, –12 V, and +24 V (in the
same way as with the IR-320 but for +3.3 V).
External electrical capacity
Power supply
Application
Total capacity
+5 V DC
PCI slot, COM ports, keyboard, USB
3.0 A
+3.3 V DC
PCI slot
1.0 A
+12 V DC
PCI slot, COM ports
1.5 A
–12 V DC
PCI slot
0.3 A
+24 V DC
Dedicated printer, external TM power supply, drawer, customer display
2.0 A
Each of these ports is restricted to the capacity limits shown below.
Electrical capacity of each port
Port
Power supply
Supply capacity
Remarks
COM ports
+5 V DC
500 mA each (peak at 1 A/100 ms)
+12 V DC
500 mA each (peak at 1 A/100 ms)
The total for all four ports must not
exceed the value shown on the left.
USB port
+5 V DC
500 mA each (peak at 1 A/100 ms)
—
Keyboard
+5 V DC
500 mA each (peak at 1 A/100 ms)
—
Drawer
+24 V DC
1A
—
CAUTION:
The USB port is not supported by Windows NT.
Lithium Battery
The IR-320 is internally equipped with a non-rechargeable Lithium Battery. This battery is used
for backing up the RTC and the CMOS RAM built in the RTC. This is different from the IR-310.
Battery type
CR-2032
Backup time
5 years
If the message “” cmos check sum error” “ appears every time the system is started up,
replace the battery.
7-8 Hardware Specifications
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
WARNING:
Be sure to use the IR-320 within the specified standard temperature range; in particular,
do not use the IR-320 at high temperatures and high humidity, and never operate it
where dew may condense on it.
The battery contains flammable substances, such as lithium and an organic solvent. Do
not short-circuit, disassemble, deform, heat, or throw the battery into a fire. The fire may
cause the battery to generate heat, burst, and ignite.
Interface
Serial Connectors
The IR-320 has four NS16550-compatible serial ports (COM1, COM2, COM5, COM6). It has four
outside connectors, however, COM5 and COM6 cannot be used by default. Assign COM5 and
COM6 to interrupts not in use.
1
5
6
9
Assignment of serial connector signals
No.
Signal name
I/O
Description
1
DCD/power supply (*)
I/—
Carrier detection signal or power supply output
2
RXD
I
Received data signal
3
TXD
O
Transmission data signal
4
DTR
O
Terminal ready signal
5
GND
—
Ground
6
DSR
I
Data set ready signal
7
RTS
O
Transmission request signal
8
CTS
I
Transmission data cleared signal
9
RI
I
Ring signal
(*) Pin 1 can be set for +5 V output and +12 V output with the jumper settings (JP7 to JP18) on the main board.
Rev. C
Hardware Specifications 7-9
Parallel Connector (LPT Connector)
The LPT connector is a 25-pin D-Sub female connector. Set the LPT port to bidirectional or EPP/
ECP mode in BIOS setup. The IR-320 does not support an OCIA interface.
13
1
25
14
Assignment of parallel connector signals
No.
Signal name
I/O
Description
1
STROBE#
O
Strobe signal
2
PD0
I/O
Data signals
3
PD1
I/O
4
PD2
I/O
5
PD3
I/O
6
PD4
I/O
7
PD5
I/O
8
PD6
I/O
9
PD7
I/O
10
ACK#
I
Acknowledge (receiving complete) signal. LOW: Receiving enabled
11
BUSY#
I
Busy signal. LOW: Busy
12
PE
I
Paper error signal. HIGH: Error
13
SLCT
I
Selection signal. HIGH: select
14
ATFD#
O
Auto-feed signal. LOW: Paper feed
15
ERR#
I
Error signal. LOW: Error
16
INIT#
O
Initialization signal. LOW: initialize
17
SLIN#
O
Printer selection signal. HIGH: Select
18 to 25
GND
—
Ground
# following a signal name indicates active LOW.
See the IEEE 1284 Specification for data signals in the EPP and ECP modes.
External TM Power Connector
The power connector for the TM printer is located on the rear panel. Connect the power cable for
the TM printer to the external TM power connector. This connector is a Hoshiden-made
TCS7960-53. Use the dedicated power cable for the external TM power connector.
•
Ratings: 24 V -3%, +7% 2 A (The current capacity includes the currents used in the
DKD connector and the customer display connector.)
7-10 Hardware Specifications
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Note:
When an exclusive printer unit is connected, the external TM power connector cannot be used.
Usable printers
Printer tray mounted type
TM-U200 series
TM-H6000 series
TM-T88II series
External type
TM-U675 series
TM-T285 series
TM-H5000 series
2
1
1
3
1
2
3
Assignment of TM connector signals
No.
I/O
Signal Name
1
—
24 VDC
2
—
GND
3
—
NC
DKD Connector
The DKD connector, which is located on the rear panel, is a connector for the cash drawer. The
connector is a 6-pin, modular connector.
‚1 P
6
DKD connector pin assignments
No.
Signal name
I/O
Description
1
FG
—
Frame ground
2
DKD1
O
Drawer 1 kick-out signal; LOW: Open
3
DK Status
I
Drawer status signal; Low/High is different with the specification
of the Drawer.
Rev. C
Hardware Specifications 7-11
DKD connector pin assignments
4
+24 V
—
+24 V (DC) of electrical power
5
DKD2
O
Drawer 2 kick-out signal; LOW: Open
6
SG
—
Signal ground
Customer Display Connector
Connect a DM-D series customer display to the customer display connector. The connector is an
8-pin modular connector.
1
8
DM-D connector pin assignments
No.
Signal name
I/O
Description
1
FG (frame GND)
—
Frame ground
2
RXD (not used)
I
Received data (not used with this unit)
3
TXD
O
Transmission data
4
DTR (not used)
O
Unit ready signal (always at ready)
5
DSR/CTS
I
Customer display ready signal
6
SG (signal GND)
—
Signal ground
7
+24 V DC
—
+24 V of electrical power
8
PGND (power GND)
—
Power supply ground
7-12 Hardware Specifications
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Appendix A
Wake On LAN
Overview
Objective of Wake On LAN
With the Wake On LAN function, one machine connected to the LAN can be powered on from
another machine also connected to that LAN through the network.
This makes it possible for the server to manage the power of all machines without the operator
having to operate the soft power switches.
Settings for Using Wake On LAN
The conditions and settings for using the Wake On LAN in the IR-320 are given below.
❏ AC power is being supplied (Main power switch is on).
❏ Onboard LAN Device and Wake-Up by PCI is enabled in the BIOS setup.
❏ The Wake On LAN application is installed in the server.
In the IR-320, Wake On LAN is supported only for the onboard LAN controller. The function
cannot be used with a general-purpose NIC via a PCI card interface.
Wake On LAN Methods
Wake On LAN can power on the IR-320 in the following two ways:
❏ Magic Packet received
Rev. C
Wake On LAN A-1
Confidential
Basic Operation
Wake Up Signal
Chipset
(82801BA)
Power On Power
Signal
Supply
Unit
Power Switch
Signal
SMI
Signal Paths in Wake On LAN
If the Chipset (82801BA) receives a Wake Up Signal from LAN or the Soft Power Switch is
pressed, it outputs a power-on signal to the power supply (if the poweris off) or an LMI signal (if
the machine is in the suspend state) to resume.
Because the wake-up signal is received by the chipset, backup is always active as long as AC
power is supplied.
Software Settings
BIOS Settings
The following settings must be made in BIOS setup to enable Wake On LAN.
Wake-Up by PCI in Power Management Setup
Disable:
Enable:
Wake On LAN disabled
Wake On LAN enabled
When this is set to Enable, a wake-up by Wake On LAN is possible. This is specifies whether or
not the chipset, shown in the figure above, recognizes the Wake On LAN signal.
Precautions
1. When a system using Wake On LAN is shut down by the OS or shut off normally by the soft
power switch, the function is enabled. If the soft power switch is pressed and held down for
4 seconds, or if the OS does not finish normally, the function is disabled.
At power off, BIOS sets the chipset for this item to off, which means the function is always
disabled when power is turned back on. If the front switch is depressed for 4 seconds, the
machine powers off without going through BIOS, and the function will be disabled
regardless of the BIOS setting.
2. If the OI-R03 battery unit is not installed, Wake On LAN is not enabled immediately after
AC power is turned on, even though the BIOS has been set. On the other hand, if the OI-R03
battery unit is installed, immediately after AC power is turned on, chipset settings are
initialized and, therefore, do not reflect BIOS settings. As a result, Wake On LAN always
must be set to on by hardware, regardless of the BIOS setting, between AC power on and the
first Wake On LAN.
A-2 Wake On LAN
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Wake On LAN Method Details
Magic Packet Received
In the Magic Packet mode, when the LAN controller detects a data pattern consisting of 6 FF
bytes and 16 repetitions of the media access control (MAC) address, it issues a wake-up request.
This special pattern cannot occur in normal communications and must be sent deliberately.
Magic Packet data for a client with a MAC address of “11-22-33-44-55-66,” for example, is as
indicated below (for example, data excluding the destination address, self address, CRC):
FF FF FF FF FF FF 11 22 33 44 55 66 11 22 33 44 55 66 11 22 33 44 55 66 11 22 33 44 55 66
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
11 22 33 44 55 66 11 22 33 44 55 66 11 22 33 44 55 66 11 22 33 44 55 66 11 22 33 44 55 66
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
11 22 33 44 55 66 11 22 33 44 55 66 11 22 33 44 55 66 11 22 33 44 55 66 11 22 33 44 55 66
(10)
(11)
(12)
(13)
(14)
11 22 33 44 55 66 11 22 33 44 55 66
(15)
(16)
Reference Information
MAC Address
Check the machine’s MAC address using the following methods:
❏ Windows 98:
Type winipcfg in the command line, and press Enter.
❏ Windows NT/2000/XP:
Type ipconfig/all in the command line, and press Enter.
Rev. C
Wake On LAN A-3
Confidential
A-4 Wake On LAN
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Appendix B
The IR-310 Compared to the IR-320
It is possible to use the IR-320 as the successor model to the IR-310, but there are several
differences; they are listed in this appendix. For more details, ask your dealer.
Hardware
Here is a comparison of the hardware.
Item
CPU
IR-310
IR-320
CPU
CeleronTM (PPGA/FCPGA)366Hz
to 733 MHz
Pentium III (FCPGA) 700MHz
CeleronTM (FCPGA2) 1.2 GHz
CeleronTM (FCPGA) 733 MHz
Socket
370pin Socket
←
Secondary cache
Memory
Pentium III (FCPGA) : 256KB
CeleronTM (FCPGA) : 128KB
CeleronTM (FCPGA2)
1.2GHz
: 256KB
CeleronTM (FCPGA): 128KB
Main Memory
168pin DIMM slot x2
3.3V SDRAM
←
256MB max PC66
512MB max PC100
256KB
512KB
Chipset
Intel440BX
Intel 810E2
VideoController
CHIPS 69000
Included in the Chipset
Memory
System ROM
TM
Video Memory
2MB
Part of the main memory is used
Ethernet
10 BASE-T / 100 BASE-TX standard
installation
Wake Up on LAN available
10 BASE-T / 100 BASE-TX
Wake On LAN and PXE(RPL)
available
Installed on the POS board
Installed on the main board
Sound
Supplement
memory
device
Rev.C
Option
Standard
Interface
No
External line input/output, mike
input
Speaker
A built-in mono speaker (with a
hardware volume)
A music CD cannot be played
with the speaker
←
FDD
3.5-inch (1-unit)(1.44MB/720KB)
←
HDD
3.5-inch (1-unit) or 2.5-inch
(2-unit) installed
IDE interface
←
5 GB - 20 GB
20 GB or more
For IDE/ UltraDMA 33
For IDE/ UltraDMA 33/66/100
CD-ROM drive
CD-R/RW drive
Installation possible as an option ←
IDE interface、boot possible
NV-RAM (option)
Available
Not available
The IR-310 Compared to the IR-320 B-1
Item
IR-310
IR-320
CompactFlash Front CompactFlash
Adapter
Installation possible instead of
the CD-ROM
←
Interface
Built-in
Available
Not available
Network
Installed on the x1 POS board
Installed on the x1 main board
Keyboard/mouse
x1 PS/2 compatible (6-pin
miniDIN)
←
Serial
x4 (D-sub 9-pin male)
+5V or +12V can be output to
No. 1 pin by setting jumpers
←
Parallel
x1(D-sub 25-pin female)EPP/
ECP compatible
←
Display
x1(D-sub 15-pin female)
←
USB
x2(Revision 1.1)
←
Customer display
x1
Installed on the x1 POS board
Drawer
x1 (2-drive)
←
External printer power
supply
Installed on the x1 (24V) POS
board
←
Sound input/output
Not available
Eternal line input/output, mike
input
Extension slot
PCI slot
x2(+3.3V is available.)Rev. 2.1
x2(+3.3V is available.)Rev. 2.2
Power Supply
Specification
100-240V 50-60Hz 180W
←
Output specification
+5V +3.3V +12V -12V +24V
AC Outlet
Two types: not available/
available (3A)
Available (3A)
AC outlet protection
Breaker or fuse
Fuse
Charging at system on
Charging prohibited
Backup
Charge
battery for RTC
Type
-
CR-2032
Data storing time
40 days (with NV-RAM)
200 days (without NV-RAM)
5 years
Battery pack
NiCd battery for data
storing at AC power
supply cut
Available (option)
←
Other
Key lock
7 positions
←
Front lock
Available
←
Dimension
252x386x261
←
Mass
6.7kg
←
Case color
EPSON cool white
←
B-2 The IR-310 Compared to the IR-320
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Hardware Configuration
Item
IR-310
IR-320
Compatible
Main board
Available
Available
No
POS board
Available
Available
No
Riser board
Available
Available
No
LVDS board
Available
Not available
No
Power suply (with AC
outlet and fuse)
Available
Available
Yes
Jumper and Switch Settings
Item
IR-310
IR-320
RTC and CMOS clear
JP5
←
COM Port power
output
JP7 to JP18
←
TM reset polarity
settings
JP31
←
TM/customer display
flow control
JP32
←
TM reset enable/
disable setting for RTS
and DTR
JP3
←
DIP switch settings for
keyboard controller
DSW1
SW1:
Start-up mode
SW2 to 4: Country settings
Default setting:
OFF, OFF, OFF = US mode
DSW1
SW4:
Start-up mode
SW1 to 3: Country settings
Default setting:
OFF, OFF, OFF = US mode
Ethernet setting
JP1
None:
Upper Surface
LCD setting
Jumper Switch JP1
Jumper JP1
1-2: DM-LR104T-252,DM-LR104SV, 1-2: DM-LR104T-252,DM-LR121SV
2-3: DM-LR104T-052
DM-LR121SV/XG
2-3: DM-LR104T-052, DM-LR104
Rear Sueface
Customer display
loop-back setting
Jumper of over the power
supply fan
Main Board
POS 320/ LVDS
Board
Rev.C
Switch (SW2) of the POS 320
board rear panel
The IR-310 Compared to the IR-320 B-3
Option Comparison
Here is a comparison of the options.
Item
LCD unit
IR-310
IR-320
DM-LR104
Can be used
Cannot be used
DM-LR104SV
Can be used
Cannot be used
DM-LR104T
Can be used
←
DM-LR121SV
Can be used
←
DM-LR121SL
Cannot be used
Can be used
DM-KR028
Can be used
←
DM-KR084
Can be used
←
DM-MR112(for
Japan)
Can be used
←
DM-MR123(for
countries except
Japan)
Can be used
←
DM-D110
Can be used
←
DM-D102-x15
Can be used
Cannot be used
DM-D210
Can be used
←
DM-D500
Can be used
←
Twin pole
OI-R08
Can be used
←
Exclusive TM printer
TM-T88IIR
Can be used
←
TM-U210AR
Can be used
←
TM-H3000R
Can be used
←
OI-R01-001
Can be used
←
OI-R01-022
Can be used
←
Keyboard
MSR unit
Customer display
Printer tray
Solid disc
OI-M04
Cannot be used
←
PCMCIA board
OI-B06
Cannot be used
←
NV-RAM
OI-M06
Can be used
Cannot be used
Sound board
OI-B07
Can be used
Cannot be used
CD-ROM drive
OI-R06-002
Can be used
←
CD-R/RW drive
OI-R06-052
Can be used
←
Front CompactFlash Adapter
OI-R07
Can be used
←
Battery pack
OI-R03
Can be used
←
B-4 The IR-310 Compared to the IR-320
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Software Comparison
Here is a comparison of the software.
Item
OS
IR-310
IR-320
Windows XP Professional
Edition pre-installed
Not available
←
Windows XP Professional
Edition commercially sold
Can be used
←
Windows 2000 Professionall
pre-installed
Available
←
Windows 2000 Professionall
commercially sold
Can be used
←
Windows NT Workstation 4.0
pre-installed
Available
←
Windows NT Workstation 4.0
commercially sold
Can be used
←
Windows 98 Second Edition
pre-installed
Available
←
Windows 98 Second Edition
commercially sold
Can be used
←
Windows 95 pre-installed
Available
Not available
Windows 95 commercially sold Can be used
Cannot be used
DOS pre-installed
Available
Not available
DOS commercially sold
Can be used
Can be used
BIOS
APM 1.2/Plug&Play/DMI
compatible/Diag
ACPI 1.0b/APM 1.2 / Plug&Play
/ DMI compatible/Diag
POS keyboard firm
Exclusive keyboard unit, MSR
unit, Keylock control firmware
←
Other
OPOS English version
1.62 ~ 1.95
2.20 SP7 or later
OPOS Japanese version
1.62 ~ 1.92
2.20J SP7 or later
Rev.C
The IR-310 Compared to the IR-320 B-5
Comparison for Driver, Tool, and Utility
Here is a comparison of the drivers, tools, and utilities. Compatibility indicates API (Application
Program Interface) compatibility. If API compatibility is Yes, applications written for the IR-310
should also work with the IR-320. However, be sure that you test any application written for the
IR-310 to confirm that it can also be used for the IR-320 before installing it.
OS
Driver/Tool/Utility
IR-310
IR-320
Change
API
Compatibilit
y
All
BIOS
power management
APM
APM/ACPI
Changed
-
Keyboard firmware
related tools for DOS
EPSON
EPSON
Not
changed
Yes
Keyboard firmware
related tools for
Windows
EPSON
EPSON
Not
changed
Yes
Layer compatible 28keyboard unit related
tools
EPSON
EPSON
Not
changed
Yes
CDROM Driver
EPSON
EPSON
Not
changed
Yes
Network Driver
Realtek
Intel
Changed
Yes
Touch Panel Driver
Fujitsu
Fujitsu
Not
changed
Yes
Chipset Driver
-
Intel
New
Yes
Power Switch Disable
tool
-
EPSON
New
Yes
Supported by BIOS
(IR-310)
AC Line watching tool -
EPSON
New
Yes
Supported by BIOS
and Windows API (IR310)
Logon tool
EPSON
EPSON
Not
changed
Yes
NVRAM utility
EPSON
-
Deleted
No
DOS
Win98SE
Remarks
Remarks
Not supported by
IR-320
Network Driver
Realtek
Intel
Changed
Yes
Sound Driver
Ess
Analog
Devices
Changed
Yes
Touch Panel Driver
EPSON
EPSON
Changed
Yes
Frequency of the
beep sound is
changed
Fujitsu
-
Deleted
No
Not supported by IR320
Chips
Intel
Changed
Yes
Video Driver
B-6 The IR-310 Compared to the IR-320
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
API
Compatibilit
y
OS
Driver/Tool/Utility
IR-310
IR-320
Change
Win NT
Logon tool
EPSON
EPSON
Not
changed
Yes
NVRAM utility
EPSON
-
Deleted
No
APM Driver
EPSON
EPSON
Not
changed
Yes
Network Driver
Realtek
Intel
Changed
Yes
Sound Driver
Ess
Analog
Devices
Changed
Yes
Touch Panel Driver
EPSON
EPSON
Not
changed
Yes
Deleted
No
Fujitsu
Win
2000
Video Driver
Chips
Intel
Changed
Yes
Screen saver
EPSON
-
Deleted
No
Rev.C
Not supported by
IR-320
Not supported by
IR-320
Not supported by
IR-320
Chipset Driver
-
Intel
New
Yes
Power Switch Disable
tool
-
EPSON
New
Yes
Supported by BIOS
(IR-310)
AC Line watching tool -
EPSON
New
No
Not supported by IR310
Serial driver
Microsoft
EPSON
Changed
Yes
For IM-320, reload of
the standby timer is
supported
Logon tool
EPSON
EPSON
Not
changed
Yes
NVRAM utility
EPSON
-
Deleted
No
Network Driver
Realtek
Intel
Changed
Yes
Sound Driver
Ess
Analog
Devices
Changed
Yes
Touch Panel Driver
EPSON
EPSON
Changed
Yes
Support with ACPI
mode is added
Deleted
No
Not supported by
IR-320
Fujitsu
Win XP
Remarks
Remarks
Video Driver
Chips
Intel
Changed
Yes
Chipset Driver
-
Intel
New
Yes
AC Line monitoring
tool
-
EPSON
New
No
Network Driver
Realtek
Intel
Changed
Yes
Touch Panel Driver
EPSON
EPSON
Changed
Yes
Video Driver
Chips
Intel
Changed
Yes
Not supported by
IR-320
Not supported by
IR-320
Support with ACPI
mode is added
The IR-310 Compared to the IR-320 B-7
B-8 The IR-310 Compared to the IR-320
Rev.C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
Appendix C
Serial Handshaking
Overview of the TM Printer and the Customer Display Connections
The recommended control line connections for the TM Printer and its peripherals are the default
settings. These are DTR/DSR flow control for the TM printer and RTS/CTS flow control for the
Customer Display.
Possible Combinations of Handshaking for the TM Printers and the Customer
Displays
When a TM-T88IIR, TM-U210AR, or TM-H3000R printer is installed on the IR-320, the DTR/
DSR line is internally connected to the TM Printer. As a result of this, customers should use
RTS/CTS line for handshaking with the Customer Display. However, if the customers change a
setting of JP32, they can use the following flow control combination.
TM Printer control:
RTS/CTS
CustomerDisplay control:
DTR/DSR
Connection Differences for Customer Displays
Unlike the TM printers that use a pass-through connection with the Customer Display, the
printers and displays for the IR-320 system have separate connections for separate flow control.
(External TM printers also require separate flow control if a Y connection is selected rather than
a pass-through connection.)
Flow Control Selections for Different Applications
If an application program is written in Visual Basic and MSCOMM is used, only RTS/CTS and
XON/XOFF are available for selection. In this case, you can set the TM Printer and the Customer
Display as follows using the ActiveX control MSCOMM:
TM Printer control:
XON/XOFF
CustomerDisplay control:
RTS/CTS
Notes:
CustomerDisplay control cannot be guaranteed with XON/XOFF.
DTR/DSR handshaking is not an option with the MSCOMM control.
Rev. C
Serial Handshaking Appendix C-1
Confidential
If an application program is written in Visual C or some other language that uses the WIN API
directly, you can set the flow control settings in either of the following ways:
When JP32 on the POS board is SHORTED
TM Printer control:
Either DTR/DSR or XON/XOFF
CustomerDisplay control:
RTS/CTS
Note:
CustomerDisplay control cannot be guaranteed with XON/XOFF.
When JP32 on the POS board is OPEN
TM Printer control:
Either XON/XOFF or RTS/CTS
CustomerDisplay control:
DTR/DSR
Notes:
CustomerDisplay control cannot be guaranteed with XON/XOFF.
Windows Settings
The recommended setting for the Windows FIFO buffer is disabled. This prevents timing delays
caused by the data being held in the buffer. If customers want the setting to be enabled, the
manufacturer recommends that the transmission buffer size be less than 16 bytes.
Device Settings When Software Requires XON/XOFF Handshaking with Jumper
JP32 Open
To set XON/XOFF handshaking, check that the IR-320 and TM Printer use the following
settings:
❏ Handshaking for the TM-xxR Printer should be set to XON/XOFF.
❏ Set DIP switch 1-3 of the TM-xxR Printer to ON. (The default setting is OFF.)
❏ Set Jumper JP32 on the POS board to OPEN. (The default setting is SHORTED.)
❏ The recommended setting for the Windows FIFO buffer is disabled. This prevents timing
delays caused by the data being held in the buffer. If customers want the setting to be
enabled, the manufacturer recommends that the transmission buffer size be less than 16
bytes.
❏ The Customer Display is still controlled by hardware handshaking (DTR/DSR).
Notes:
You cannot use RTS/CTS handshaking to control the TM printer.
The Customer Display is set to DTR/DSR to keep it from going BUSY.
Appendix C-2 Serial Handshaking
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
The illustration below shows the final electrical connection.
With Jumper JP32 on the POS Board OPEN
Device Settings When Software Requires XON/XOFF Handshaking with Jumper
JP32 Shorted
To set XON/XOFF handshaking, check that the IR-320 and the TM Printer use the following
settings:
❏ Handshaking for the TM-xxR Printer should be set to XON/XOFF.
❏ Set DIP switch 1-3 of the TM-xxR Printer to ON. (The default setting is OFF.)
❏ Set Jumper JP32 on the POS board to SHORTED. (This is the default setting.)
❏ The recommended setting for the Windows FIFO buffer is disabled. This prevents timing
delays caused by the data being held in the buffer. If customers want the setting to be
enabled, the manufacturer recommends that the transmission buffer size be less than 16
bytes.
❏ The Customer Display is still controlled by hardware handshaking (RTS/CTS).
Notes:
You cannot use DTR/DSR handshaking to control the TM Printer.
The Customer Display is set to RTS/CTS to keep it from going BUSY.
Rev. C
Serial Handshaking Appendix C-3
Confidential
The illustration below shows the final electrical connection.
With Jumper JP32 POS Board SHORTED (Default)
Device Settings When Software Requires DTR/DSR Handshaking
To set DTR/DSR handshaking, check that the IR-320 and the TM Printer use the following
settings:
❏ Handshaking for the TM-xxR Printer should be set to DTR/DSR.
❏ Set DIP switch 1-3 of the TM-xxR Printer to OFF. (This is the default setting.)
❏ Set Jumper JP32 on the POS board to SHORTED. (This is the default setting.)
❏ The recommended setting for the Windows FIFO buffer is disabled. This prevents timing
delays caused by the data being held in the buffer. If customers want the setting to be
enabled, the manufacturer recommends that the transmission buffer size be less than 16
bytes.
❏ The Customer Display is controlled by RTS/CTS handshaking.
Notes:
You cannot use RTS/CTS handshaking to control the TM Printer.
You cannot use XON/XOFF handshaking to control the Customer Display, because the Customer
Display can use DTR/DSR handshaking only.
The Windows serial driver (DLL), Visual Basic command, or MFC control the DTR/DSR flow.
Appendix C-4 Serial Handshaking
Rev. C
IR-320 Technical Reference Manual
The illustration below shows the final electrical connection.
With Jumper JP32 on the POS Board SHORTED
Device Settings When Software Requires RTS/CTS Handshaking
To set RTS/CTS handshaking, check that the IR-320 and the TM Printer use the following
settings:
❏ Handshaking for the TM-xxR Printer should be set to RTS/CTS.
❏ Set DIP switch 1-3 of the TM-xxR Printer to OFF. (This is the default setting.)
❏ Set Jumper JP32 on the POS board to OPEN. (The default setting is SHORTED.)
❏ The recommended setting for the Windows FIFO buffer is disabled. This prevents timing
delays caused by the data being held in the buffer. If customers want the setting to be
enabled, the manufacturer recommends that the transmission buffer size be less than 16
bytes.
❏ The Customer Display is controlled by DTR/DSR handshaking.
Rev. C
Serial Handshaking Appendix C-5
Confidential
The illustration below shows the final electrical connection.
With Jumper JP32 on the POS Board
Appendix C-6 Serial Handshaking
Rev. C
EPSON
SEIKO EPSON CORPORATION

advertisement

Related manuals

Download PDF

advertisement